* config/tc-m68hc11.c (md_begin): Take into account additional
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
8a037dd7 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
959acfd1 34@set DATE December 2001
c906108c 35
6c0e9fb3 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
8a037dd7
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
54 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
59Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
60Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
6826cf00
EZ
63(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
64freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
65published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
66development.''
c906108c
SS
67@end ifinfo
68
69@titlepage
70@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
71@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 72@sp 1
c906108c
SS
73@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
74@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 76@page
c906108c
SS
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
53a5351d 84
c906108c 85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7
EZ
86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 88@sp 2
c906108c
SS
89Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9059 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 92ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
93
94Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
97Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 100
6826cf00
EZ
101(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104development.''
c906108c
SS
105@end titlepage
106@page
107
6c0e9fb3 108@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
109@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
c906108c
SS
111@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
5d161b24 115This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
116@value{GDBVN}.
117
8a037dd7 118Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
119
120@menu
121* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128* Stack:: Examining the stack
129* Source:: Examining source files
130* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 131* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 132* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 133* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
134
135* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138* Altering:: Altering execution
139* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 141* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
142* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 145* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
146* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
147* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 148* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
149
150* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
151* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
152
153* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
154* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
155* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 156* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 157* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
158* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
159 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 160* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
161* Index:: Index
162@end menu
163
6c0e9fb3 164@end ifnottex
c906108c 165
449f3b6c 166@contents
449f3b6c 167
6d2ebf8b 168@node Summary
c906108c
SS
169@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
170
171The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
172going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
173program was doing at the moment it crashed.
174
175@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
176these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
177
178@itemize @bullet
179@item
180Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
181
182@item
183Make your program stop on specified conditions.
184
185@item
186Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
187
188@item
189Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
190effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
191@end itemize
192
cce74817 193You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 194For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
195For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
196
db034ac5 197@c OBSOLETE @cindex Chill
cce74817 198@cindex Modula-2
db034ac5
AC
199Support for Modula-2
200@c OBSOLETE and Chill
201is partial. For information on Modula-2, see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
202@c OBSOLETE For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 203
cce74817
JM
204@cindex Pascal
205Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208syntax.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@cindex Fortran
211@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 212it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 213underscore.
c906108c 214
c906108c
SS
215@menu
216* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218@end menu
219
6d2ebf8b 220@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
221@unnumberedsec Free software
222
5d161b24 223@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
224General Public License
225(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234from anyone else.
235
2666264b 236@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
237
238The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240include with the free software. Many of our most important
241programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243when an important free software package does not come with a free
244manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245gaps today.
246
247Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251them from the free software world.
252
253That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257contract to make it non-free.
258
259Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278community.
279
280Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288of the manual.
289
290However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294manual to replace it.
295
296Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301the free software community.
302
303If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 311is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
312
313You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
319Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
321
322The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323published by other publishers, at
324@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
6d2ebf8b 326@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
327@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
335blow-by-blow account.
336
337Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339@quotation
340@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343@end quotation
344
345So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347releases:
b37052ae 348Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
349Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
b37052ae
EZ
361Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 366
b37052ae 367@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
368object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
96c405b3 374Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
375
376Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378support.
379Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
394
395Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
396
397Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
398libraries.
399
400Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
401about several machine instruction sets.
402
403Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
404remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
405contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
406and RDI targets, respectively.
407
408Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
409command-line editing and command history.
410
7a292a7a
SS
411Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
412Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 413
5d161b24 414Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 415He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 416symbols.
c906108c
SS
417
418Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
419Super-H processors.
420
421NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
422
423Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
424
425Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
426
427Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
428
96a2c332 429Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
430
431Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
432watchpoints.
433
434Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
435
436Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
437
438Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 439nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
440
441The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
442support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 443(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
444compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
445John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
446Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
447information in this manual.
448
b37052ae
EZ
449DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
450Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
451
96a2c332
SS
452Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
453development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
454fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
455Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
456Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
457Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
458Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
459addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
460JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
461Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
462Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
463Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
464Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
465Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
466Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 467
e2e0bcd1
JB
468Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
469Hat.
c906108c 470
6d2ebf8b 471@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
472@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
473
474You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
475However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
476debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
477
478@iftex
479In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
480to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
481@end iftex
482
483@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
484@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
485
486One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
487processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
488quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
489definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
490session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
491then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
492same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
493@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
494procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
495
496@smallexample
497$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
498$ @b{./m4}
499@b{define(foo,0000)}
500
501@b{foo}
5020000
503@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
504
505@b{bar}
5060000
507@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
508
509@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
510@b{baz}
511@b{C-d}
512m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
513@end smallexample
514
515@noindent
516Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
517
c906108c
SS
518@smallexample
519$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
520@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
521@c FIXME... format to come out better.
522@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 523 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 524 the conditions.
5d161b24 525There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
526 for details.
527
528@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
529(@value{GDBP})
530@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
531
532@noindent
533@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
534rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
535We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
536that examples fit in this manual.
537
538@smallexample
539(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
540@end smallexample
541
542@noindent
543We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
544Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
545@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
546@code{break} command.
547
548@smallexample
549(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
550Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
551@end smallexample
552
553@noindent
554Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
555control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
556subroutine, the program runs as usual:
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
560Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
561@b{define(foo,0000)}
562
563@b{foo}
5640000
565@end smallexample
566
567@noindent
568To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
569suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
570context where it stops.
571
572@smallexample
573@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
574
5d161b24 575Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
576 at builtin.c:879
577879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
578@end smallexample
579
580@noindent
581Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
582the next line of the current function.
583
584@smallexample
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
587 : nil,
588@end smallexample
589
590@noindent
591@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
592by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
593@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
594subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
595
596@smallexample
597(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
598set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
599 at input.c:530
600530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
601@end smallexample
602
603@noindent
604The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
605suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
606shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
607command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
608in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
609stack frame for each active subroutine.
610
611@smallexample
612(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
613#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
614 at input.c:530
5d161b24 615#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
616 at builtin.c:882
617#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
618#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
619 at macro.c:71
620#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
621#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
622@end smallexample
623
624@noindent
625We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
626times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
627falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
628
629@smallexample
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6310x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6330x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
634def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
635(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
636536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
637 : xstrdup(rq);
638(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
640@end smallexample
641
642@noindent
643The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
644@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
645and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
646(@code{print}) to see their values.
647
648@smallexample
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
650$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
651(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
652$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
653@end smallexample
654
655@noindent
656@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
657To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
658surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
659
660@smallexample
661(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
662533 xfree(rquote);
663534
664535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
665 : xstrdup (lq);
666536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
667 : xstrdup (rq);
668537
669538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
670539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
671540 @}
672541
673542 void
674@end smallexample
675
676@noindent
677Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
678@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
679
680@smallexample
681(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
682539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
683(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684540 @}
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
686$3 = 9
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
688$4 = 7
689@end smallexample
690
691@noindent
692That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
693@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
694@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
695the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
696any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
697assignments.
698
699@smallexample
700(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
701$5 = 7
702(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
703$6 = 9
704@end smallexample
705
706@noindent
707Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
708@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
709executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
710example that caused trouble initially:
711
712@smallexample
713(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
714Continuing.
715
716@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
717
718baz
7190000
720@end smallexample
721
722@noindent
723Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
724problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
725lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
726
727@smallexample
728@b{C-d}
729Program exited normally.
730@end smallexample
731
732@noindent
733The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
734indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
735session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
736
737@smallexample
738(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
739@end smallexample
c906108c 740
6d2ebf8b 741@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
742@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
743
744This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 745The essentials are:
c906108c 746@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 747@item
53a5351d 748type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 749@item
c906108c
SS
750type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
751@end itemize
752
753@menu
754* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
755* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
756* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
757@end menu
758
6d2ebf8b 759@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
760@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
761
c906108c
SS
762Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
763@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
764
765You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
766to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
767
c906108c
SS
768The command-line options described here are designed
769to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 770options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
771
772The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
773specifying an executable program:
774
474c8240 775@smallexample
c906108c 776@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 777@end smallexample
c906108c 778
c906108c
SS
779@noindent
780You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
781specified:
782
474c8240 783@smallexample
c906108c 784@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 785@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
786
787You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
788to debug a running process:
789
474c8240 790@smallexample
c906108c 791@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 792@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
793
794@noindent
795would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
796named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
797
c906108c 798Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
799complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
800debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
801``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
802will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 803
aa26fa3a
TT
804You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
805executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
806option processing.
474c8240 807@smallexample
aa26fa3a 808gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 809@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
810This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
811@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
812
96a2c332 813You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
814@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
815
816@smallexample
817@value{GDBP} -silent
818@end smallexample
819
820@noindent
821You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
822options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
823
824@noindent
825Type
826
474c8240 827@smallexample
c906108c 828@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
830
831@noindent
832to display all available options and briefly describe their use
833(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
834
835All options and command line arguments you give are processed
836in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
837@samp{-x} option is used.
838
839
840@menu
c906108c
SS
841* File Options:: Choosing files
842* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
843@end menu
844
6d2ebf8b 845@node File Options
c906108c
SS
846@subsection Choosing files
847
2df3850c 848When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
849specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
850the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
851@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
852first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
853equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
854second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
855equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
856If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
857first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
858to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
859a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 860prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
861
862If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
863such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
864argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
865
866Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
867following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
868them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
869(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
870than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
871
d700128c
EZ
872@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
873@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
874@c it.
875
c906108c
SS
876@table @code
877@item -symbols @var{file}
878@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
879@cindex @code{--symbols}
880@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
881Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
882
883@item -exec @var{file}
884@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
885@cindex @code{--exec}
886@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
887Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
888and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
889
890@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 891@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
892Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
893file.
894
c906108c
SS
895@item -core @var{file}
896@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
897@cindex @code{--core}
898@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 899Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
900
901@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
902@item -pid @var{number}
903@itemx -p @var{number}
904@cindex @code{--pid}
905@cindex @code{-p}
906Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
907If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
908file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
909
910@item -command @var{file}
911@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
912@cindex @code{--command}
913@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
914Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
915Files,, Command files}.
916
917@item -directory @var{directory}
918@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
919@cindex @code{--directory}
920@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
921Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
922
c906108c
SS
923@item -m
924@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
925@cindex @code{--mapped}
926@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
927@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
928supported on all systems.}@*
929If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 930system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
931to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
932program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 933called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
934Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
935and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
936the symbol table from the executable program.
937
938The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
939is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
940table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 941
c906108c
SS
942@item -r
943@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
944@cindex @code{--readnow}
945@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
946Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
947the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
948This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 949
c906108c
SS
950@end table
951
2df3850c 952You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 953order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
954information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
955on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
956but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 957
474c8240 958@smallexample
2df3850c 959gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 960@end smallexample
c906108c 961
6d2ebf8b 962@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
963@subsection Choosing modes
964
965You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
966batch mode or quiet mode.
967
968@table @code
969@item -nx
970@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
971@cindex @code{--nx}
972@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 973Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
974@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
975options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
976files}.
c906108c
SS
977
978@item -quiet
d700128c 979@itemx -silent
c906108c 980@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
981@cindex @code{--quiet}
982@cindex @code{--silent}
983@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
984``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
985messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
986
987@item -batch
d700128c 988@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
989Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
990command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
991initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
992nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
993in the command files.
994
2df3850c
JM
995Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
996example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
997make this more useful, the message
c906108c 998
474c8240 999@smallexample
c906108c 1000Program exited normally.
474c8240 1001@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1002
1003@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1004(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1005@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1006mode.
1007
1008@item -nowindows
1009@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1010@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1011@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1012``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1013(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1014interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1015
1016@item -windows
1017@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1018@cindex @code{--windows}
1019@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1020If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1021used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1022
1023@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1024@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1025Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1026instead of the current directory.
1027
c906108c
SS
1028@item -fullname
1029@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1030@cindex @code{--fullname}
1031@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1032@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1033subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1034number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1035displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1036recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1037the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1038and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1039@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1040frame.
c906108c 1041
d700128c
EZ
1042@item -epoch
1043@cindex @code{--epoch}
1044The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1045@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1046routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1047separate window.
1048
1049@item -annotate @var{level}
1050@cindex @code{--annotate}
1051This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1052effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1053(@pxref{Annotations}).
1054Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1055together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1056types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1057@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1058maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1059
1060@item -async
1061@cindex @code{--async}
1062Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1063@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1064special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1065commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1066run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1067MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1068suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1069control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1070(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1071operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1072yet.)
1073@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1074@c should be removed.
1075
1076When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1077uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1078@samp{-noasync} option.
1079
1080@item -noasync
1081@cindex @code{--noasync}
1082Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1083
aa26fa3a
TT
1084@item --args
1085@cindex @code{--args}
1086Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1087executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1088This option stops option processing.
1089
2df3850c
JM
1090@item -baud @var{bps}
1091@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1092@cindex @code{--baud}
1093@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1094Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1095interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1096
1097@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1098@itemx -t @var{device}
1099@cindex @code{--tty}
1100@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1101Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1102@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1103
53a5351d 1104@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1105@item -tui
1106@cindex @code{--tui}
1107Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1108The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1109showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1110(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1111Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1112(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1113
1114@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1115@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1116@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1117@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1118@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1119@c systems.
1120
d700128c
EZ
1121@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1122@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1123Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1124program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1125communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1126
1127@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1128@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1129@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1130@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1131
1132@item -write
1133@cindex @code{--write}
1134Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1135is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1136(@pxref{Patching}).
1137
1138@item -statistics
1139@cindex @code{--statistics}
1140This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1141memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1142
1143@item -version
1144@cindex @code{--version}
1145This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1146no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1147
c906108c
SS
1148@end table
1149
6d2ebf8b 1150@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1151@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1152@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1153@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1154
1155@table @code
1156@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1157@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1158@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1159@itemx q
1160To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1161@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1162do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1163otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1164error code.
c906108c
SS
1165@end table
1166
1167@cindex interrupt
1168An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1169terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1170returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1171character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1172until a time when it is safe.
1173
c906108c
SS
1174If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1175device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1176(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1177
6d2ebf8b 1178@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1179@section Shell commands
1180
1181If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1182debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1183just use the @code{shell} command.
1184
1185@table @code
1186@kindex shell
1187@cindex shell escape
1188@item shell @var{command string}
1189Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1190If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1191shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1192(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1193@end table
1194
1195The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1196You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1197@value{GDBN}:
1198
1199@table @code
1200@kindex make
1201@cindex calling make
1202@item make @var{make-args}
1203Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1204arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1205@end table
1206
6d2ebf8b 1207@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1208@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1209
1210You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1211name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1212@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1213key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1214show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1215
1216@menu
1217* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1218* Completion:: Command completion
1219* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1220@end menu
1221
6d2ebf8b 1222@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1223@section Command syntax
1224
1225A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1226how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1227arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1228command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1229step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1230with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1231
1232@cindex abbreviation
1233@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1234unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1235documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1236abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1237equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1238names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1239arguments to the @code{help} command.
1240
1241@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1242@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1243A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1244repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1245will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1246repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1247repeat.
1248
1249The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1250@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1251exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1252
1253@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1254output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1255(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1256@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1257repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1258
41afff9a 1259@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1260@cindex comment
1261Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1262nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1263Files,,Command files}).
1264
88118b3a
TT
1265@cindex repeating command sequences
1266@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1267The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1268commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1269then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1270for editing.
1271
6d2ebf8b 1272@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1273@section Command completion
1274
1275@cindex completion
1276@cindex word completion
1277@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1278only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1279are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1280commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1281
1282Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1283of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1284word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1285enter it). For example, if you type
1286
1287@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1288@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1289@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1290@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1291@smallexample
c906108c 1292(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1293@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1294
1295@noindent
1296@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1297the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1298
474c8240 1299@smallexample
c906108c 1300(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1301@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1302
1303@noindent
1304You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1305breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1306@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1307were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1308might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1309to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1310
1311If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1312@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1313characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1314@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1315example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1316begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1317just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1318function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1319example:
1320
474c8240 1321@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1322(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1323@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1324make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1325make_abs_section make_function_type
1326make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1327make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1328make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1329(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1330@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1331
1332@noindent
1333After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1334partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1335command.
1336
1337If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1338can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1339means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1340key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1341one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1342
1343@cindex quotes in commands
1344@cindex completion of quoted strings
1345Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1346parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1347its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1348situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1349@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1350
c906108c 1351The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1352name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1353overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1354by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1355may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1356that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1357that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1358word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1359@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1360@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1361when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1362
474c8240 1363@smallexample
96a2c332 1364(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1365bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1366(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1367@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1368
1369In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1370quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1371completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1372place:
1373
474c8240 1374@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1375(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1376@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1377(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1378@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1379
1380@noindent
1381In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1382you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1383completion on an overloaded symbol.
1384
d4f3574e 1385For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1386expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1387overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1388see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1389
1390
6d2ebf8b 1391@node Help
c906108c
SS
1392@section Getting help
1393@cindex online documentation
1394@kindex help
1395
5d161b24 1396You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1397using the command @code{help}.
1398
1399@table @code
41afff9a 1400@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1401@item help
1402@itemx h
1403You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1404display a short list of named classes of commands:
1405
1406@smallexample
1407(@value{GDBP}) help
1408List of classes of commands:
1409
2df3850c 1410aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1411breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1412data -- Examining data
c906108c 1413files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1414internals -- Maintenance commands
1415obscure -- Obscure features
1416running -- Running the program
1417stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1418status -- Status inquiries
1419support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1420tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1421 stopping the program
c906108c 1422user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1423
5d161b24 1424Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1425commands in that class.
5d161b24 1426Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1427documentation.
1428Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1429(@value{GDBP})
1430@end smallexample
96a2c332 1431@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1432
1433@item help @var{class}
1434Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1435list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1436help display for the class @code{status}:
1437
1438@smallexample
1439(@value{GDBP}) help status
1440Status inquiries.
1441
1442List of commands:
1443
1444@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1445@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1446info -- Generic command for showing things
1447 about the program being debugged
1448show -- Generic command for showing things
1449 about the debugger
c906108c 1450
5d161b24 1451Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1452documentation.
1453Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1454(@value{GDBP})
1455@end smallexample
1456
1457@item help @var{command}
1458With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1459short paragraph on how to use that command.
1460
6837a0a2
DB
1461@kindex apropos
1462@item apropos @var{args}
1463The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1464commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1465@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1466
1467@smallexample
1468apropos reload
1469@end smallexample
1470
b37052ae
EZ
1471@noindent
1472results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1473
1474@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1475@c @group
1476set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1477 multiple times in one run
1478show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1479 multiple times in one run
1480@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1481@end smallexample
1482
c906108c
SS
1483@kindex complete
1484@item complete @var{args}
1485The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1486for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1487command you want completed. For example:
1488
1489@smallexample
1490complete i
1491@end smallexample
1492
1493@noindent results in:
1494
1495@smallexample
1496@group
2df3850c
JM
1497if
1498ignore
c906108c
SS
1499info
1500inspect
c906108c
SS
1501@end group
1502@end smallexample
1503
1504@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1505@end table
1506
1507In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1508and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1509of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1510manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1511under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1512all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1513
1514@c @group
1515@table @code
1516@kindex info
41afff9a 1517@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1518@item info
1519This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1520program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1521with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1522registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1523You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1524@w{@code{help info}}.
1525
1526@kindex set
1527@item set
5d161b24 1528You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1529@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1530@code{set prompt $}.
1531
1532@kindex show
1533@item show
5d161b24 1534In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1535@value{GDBN} itself.
1536You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1537related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1538system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1539which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1540
1541@kindex info set
1542To display all the settable parameters and their current
1543values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1544@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1545@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1546@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1547@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1548@end table
1549@c @end group
1550
1551Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1552exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1553
1554@table @code
1555@kindex show version
1556@cindex version number
1557@item show version
1558Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1559information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1560@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1561version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1562commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1563system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1564variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1565The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1566@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1567
1568@kindex show copying
1569@item show copying
1570Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1571
1572@kindex show warranty
1573@item show warranty
2df3850c 1574Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1575if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1576
c906108c
SS
1577@end table
1578
6d2ebf8b 1579@node Running
c906108c
SS
1580@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1581
1582When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1583debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1584
1585You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1586of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1587your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1588kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1589
1590@menu
1591* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1592* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1593* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1594* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1595
1596* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1597* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1598* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1599* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1600
1601* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1602* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1603@end menu
1604
6d2ebf8b 1605@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1606@section Compiling for debugging
1607
1608In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1609debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1610is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1611variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1612and addresses in the executable code.
1613
1614To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1615the compiler.
1616
e2e0bcd1
JB
1617Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1618the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1619because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1620the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1621options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1622debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1623``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1624to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1625@option{-g} alone.
1626
c906108c
SS
1627Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1628options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1629executables containing debugging information.
1630
53a5351d
JM
1631@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1632without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1633recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1634program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1635in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1636
1637@cindex optimized code, debugging
1638@cindex debugging optimized code
1639When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1640optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1641really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1642exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1643variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1644variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1645
1646Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1647@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1648doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1649please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1650
1651Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1652@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1653format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1654
1655@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1656@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1657@section Starting your program
1658@cindex starting
1659@cindex running
1660
1661@table @code
1662@kindex run
41afff9a 1663@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1664@item run
1665@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1666Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1667You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1668argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1669@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1670(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1671
1672@end table
1673
c906108c
SS
1674If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1675supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1676that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1677@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1678
1679The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1680receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1681information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1682can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1683your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1684divided into four categories:
1685
1686@table @asis
1687@item The @emph{arguments.}
1688Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1689@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1690is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1691(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1692the arguments.
1693In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1694@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1695@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1696
1697@item The @emph{environment.}
1698Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1699use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1700environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1701your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1702
1703@item The @emph{working directory.}
1704Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1705the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1706@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1707
1708@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1709Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1710standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1711in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1712set a different device for your program.
1713@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1714
1715@cindex pipes
1716@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1717pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1718program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1719wrong program.
1720@end table
c906108c
SS
1721
1722When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1723immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1724of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1725stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1726or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1727
1728If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1729time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1730table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1731your current breakpoints.
1732
6d2ebf8b 1733@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1734@section Your program's arguments
1735
1736@cindex arguments (to your program)
1737The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1738@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1739They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1740performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1741@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1742@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1743the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1744
1745On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1746@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1747calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1748the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1749
1750@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1751@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1752
c906108c 1753@table @code
41afff9a 1754@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1755@item set args
1756Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1757@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1758with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1759using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1760it again without arguments.
1761
1762@kindex show args
1763@item show args
1764Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1765@end table
1766
6d2ebf8b 1767@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1768@section Your program's environment
1769
1770@cindex environment (of your program)
1771The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1772their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1773your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1774path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1775the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1776debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1777environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1778
1779@table @code
1780@kindex path
1781@item path @var{directory}
1782Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1783(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1784The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1785You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1786system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1787MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1788is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1789
1790You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1791working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1792use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1793@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1794@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1795@var{directory} to the search path.
1796@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1797@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1798
1799@kindex show paths
1800@item show paths
1801Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1802environment variable).
1803
1804@kindex show environment
1805@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1806Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1807your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1808print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1809your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1810
1811@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1812@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1813Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1814changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1815be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1816any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1817parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1818null value.
1819@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1820@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1821
1822For example, this command:
1823
474c8240 1824@smallexample
c906108c 1825set env USER = foo
474c8240 1826@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1827
1828@noindent
d4f3574e 1829tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1830@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1831are not actually required.)
1832
1833@kindex unset environment
1834@item unset environment @var{varname}
1835Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1836program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1837@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1838rather than assigning it an empty value.
1839@end table
1840
d4f3574e
SS
1841@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1842the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1843by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1844@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1845that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1846@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1847your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1848files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1849@file{.profile}.
1850
6d2ebf8b 1851@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1852@section Your program's working directory
1853
1854@cindex working directory (of your program)
1855Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1856working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1857The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1858from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1859working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1860
1861The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1862that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1863specify files}.
1864
1865@table @code
1866@kindex cd
1867@item cd @var{directory}
1868Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1869
1870@kindex pwd
1871@item pwd
1872Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1873@end table
1874
6d2ebf8b 1875@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1876@section Your program's input and output
1877
1878@cindex redirection
1879@cindex i/o
1880@cindex terminal
1881By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1882the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1883to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1884modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1885running your program.
1886
1887@table @code
1888@kindex info terminal
1889@item info terminal
1890Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1891program is using.
1892@end table
1893
1894You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1895redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1896
474c8240 1897@smallexample
c906108c 1898run > outfile
474c8240 1899@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1900
1901@noindent
1902starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1903
1904@kindex tty
1905@cindex controlling terminal
1906Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1907with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1908argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1909commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1910process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1911
474c8240 1912@smallexample
c906108c 1913tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1914@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@noindent
1917directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1918default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1919that as their controlling terminal.
1920
1921An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1922effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1923terminal.
1924
1925When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1926command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1927for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1928
6d2ebf8b 1929@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1930@section Debugging an already-running process
1931@kindex attach
1932@cindex attach
1933
1934@table @code
1935@item attach @var{process-id}
1936This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1937outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1938targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1939find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1940or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1941
1942@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1943executing the command.
1944@end table
1945
1946To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1947which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1948programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1949also have permission to send the process a signal.
1950
1951When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1952the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1953the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1954(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1955the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1956Specify Files}.
1957
1958The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1959process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1960with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1961you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1962can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1963process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1964attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1965
1966@table @code
1967@kindex detach
1968@item detach
1969When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1970@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1971the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1972that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1973are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1974@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1975executing the command.
1976@end table
1977
1978If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1979attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1980for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1981control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1982confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1983messages}).
1984
6d2ebf8b 1985@node Kill Process
c906108c 1986@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1987
1988@table @code
1989@kindex kill
1990@item kill
1991Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1992@end table
1993
1994This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1995running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1996is running.
1997
1998On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1999while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2000@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2001outside the debugger.
2002
2003The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2004relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2005executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2006next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2007reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2008breakpoint settings).
2009
6d2ebf8b 2010@node Threads
c906108c 2011@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2012
2013@cindex threads of execution
2014@cindex multiple threads
2015@cindex switching threads
2016In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2017may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2018of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2019the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2020that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2021modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2022registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2023
2024@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2025programs:
2026
2027@itemize @bullet
2028@item automatic notification of new threads
2029@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2030@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2031@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2032a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2033@item thread-specific breakpoints
2034@end itemize
2035
c906108c
SS
2036@quotation
2037@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2038@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2039If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2040effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2041from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2042like this:
2043
2044@smallexample
2045(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2046(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2047Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2048see the IDs of currently known threads.
2049@end smallexample
2050@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2051@c doesn't support threads"?
2052@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@cindex focus of debugging
2055@cindex current thread
2056The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2057threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2058control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2059This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2060program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2061
41afff9a 2062@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2063@cindex thread identifier (system)
2064@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2065@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2066@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2067Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2068the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2069form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2070whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2071LynxOS, you might see
2072
474c8240 2073@smallexample
c906108c 2074[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2075@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2076
2077@noindent
2078when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2079the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2080further qualifier.
2081
2082@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2083@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2084@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2085@c program?
2086@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2087@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2088@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2089
2090@cindex thread number
2091@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2092For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2093number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2094
2095@table @code
2096@kindex info threads
2097@item info threads
2098Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2099program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2100
2101@enumerate
2102@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2103
2104@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2105
2106@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2107@end enumerate
2108
2109@noindent
2110An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2111indicates the current thread.
2112
5d161b24 2113For example,
c906108c
SS
2114@end table
2115@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2116
2117@smallexample
2118(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2119 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2121* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2122 at threadtest.c:68
2123@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2124
2125On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2126
2127@cindex thread number
2128@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2129For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2130number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2131thread in your program.
2132
41afff9a
EZ
2133@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2134@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2135@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2136@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2137@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2138Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2139both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2140form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2141whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2142HP-UX, you see
2143
474c8240 2144@smallexample
c906108c 2145[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2146@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2147
2148@noindent
5d161b24 2149when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@table @code
2152@kindex info threads
2153@item info threads
2154Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2155program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2156
2157@enumerate
2158@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2159
2160@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2161
2162@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2163@end enumerate
2164
2165@noindent
2166An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2167indicates the current thread.
2168
5d161b24 2169For example,
c906108c
SS
2170@end table
2171@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2172
474c8240 2173@smallexample
c906108c 2174(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2175 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2176 at quicksort.c:137
2177 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2178 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2179 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2180 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2181@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2182
2183@table @code
2184@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2185@item thread @var{threadno}
2186Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2187argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2188shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2189@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2190you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2191
2192@smallexample
2193@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2194(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2195[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21960x34e5 in sigpause ()
2197@end smallexample
2198
2199@noindent
2200As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2201@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2202threads.
c906108c
SS
2203
2204@kindex thread apply
2205@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2206The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2207more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2208with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2209@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2210threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2211@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2212@end table
2213
2214@cindex automatic thread selection
2215@cindex switching threads automatically
2216@cindex threads, automatic switching
2217Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2218signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2219signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2220message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2221thread.
2222
2223@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2224more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2225programs with multiple threads.
2226
2227@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2228watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2229
6d2ebf8b 2230@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2231@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2232
2233@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2234@cindex multiple processes
2235@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2236On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2237programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2238function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2239parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2240set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2241will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2242will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2243
2244However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2245which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2246the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2247only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2248so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2249on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2250get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2251@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2252the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2253the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2254
53a5351d
JM
2255On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2256debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2257@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2258
2259By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2260the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2261
2262If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2263use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2264
2265@table @code
2266@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2267@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2268Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2269@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2270process. The @var{mode} can be:
2271
2272@table @code
2273@item parent
2274The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2275unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2276
2277@item child
2278The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2279unimpeded.
2280
2281@item ask
2282The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2283@end table
2284
2285@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2286Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2287@end table
2288
2289If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2290@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2291breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2292@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2293the child process's @code{main}.
2294
2295When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2296child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2297
2298If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2299call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2300use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2301argument.
2302
2303You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2304a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2305Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2306
6d2ebf8b 2307@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2308@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2309
2310The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2311program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2312trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2313
7a292a7a
SS
2314Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2315such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2316@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2317change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2318continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2319ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2320explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2321
2322@table @code
2323@kindex info program
2324@item info program
2325Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2326running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2327@end table
2328
2329@menu
2330* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2331* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2332* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2333* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2334@end menu
2335
6d2ebf8b 2336@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2337@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2338
2339@cindex breakpoints
2340A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2341the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2342control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2343breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2344Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2345should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2346program.
2347
2348In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2349breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2350a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2351is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2352not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2353arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2354
2355@cindex watchpoints
2356@cindex memory tracing
2357@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2358@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2359A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2360when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2361command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2362watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2363any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2364and watchpoints using the same commands.
2365
2366You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2367whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2368Automatic display}.
2369
2370@cindex catchpoints
2371@cindex breakpoint on events
2372A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2373when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2374exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2375different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2376catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2377other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2378@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2379
2380@cindex breakpoint numbers
2381@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2382@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2383catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2384starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2385features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2386breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2387@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2388enable it again.
2389
c5394b80
JM
2390@cindex breakpoint ranges
2391@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2392Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2393operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2394@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2395hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2396all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2397
c906108c
SS
2398@menu
2399* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2400* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2401* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2402* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2403* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2404* Conditions:: Break conditions
2405* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2406* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2407* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2408@end menu
2409
6d2ebf8b 2410@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2411@subsection Setting breakpoints
2412
5d161b24 2413@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2414@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2415@c
2416@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2417
2418@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2419@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2420@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2421@cindex latest breakpoint
2422Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2423@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2424number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2425Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2426convenience variables.
2427
2428You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2429
2430@table @code
2431@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2432Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2433When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2434C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2435@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2436
2437@item break +@var{offset}
2438@itemx break -@var{offset}
2439Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2440at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2441(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2442
2443@item break @var{linenum}
2444Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2445The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2446The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2447code on that line.
2448
2449@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2450Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2453Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2454@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2455superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2456functions.
2457
2458@item break *@var{address}
2459Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2460breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2461information or source files.
2462
2463@item break
2464When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2465the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2466(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2467innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2468returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2469@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2470that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2471@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2472the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2473inside loops.
2474
2475@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2476least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2477would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2478breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2479existed when your program stopped.
2480
2481@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2482Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2483@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2484value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2485@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2486above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2487,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2488
2489@kindex tbreak
2490@item tbreak @var{args}
2491Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2492same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2493way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2494program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2495
c906108c
SS
2496@kindex hbreak
2497@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2498Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2499@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2500breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2501have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2502debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2503changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2504provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2505will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2506address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2507breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2508example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2509@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2510or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2511(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2512
2513@kindex thbreak
2514@item thbreak @var{args}
2515Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2516are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2517the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2518the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2519first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2520command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2521may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2522See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2523
2524@kindex rbreak
2525@cindex regular expression
2526@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2527Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2528@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2529matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2530breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2531the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2532them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2533
2534The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2535like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2536shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2537an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2538@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2539match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2540
b37052ae 2541When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2542breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2543classes.
c906108c
SS
2544
2545@kindex info breakpoints
2546@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2547@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2548@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2549@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2550Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2551not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2552
2553@table @emph
2554@item Breakpoint Numbers
2555@item Type
2556Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2557@item Disposition
2558Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2559@item Enabled or Disabled
2560Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2561that are not enabled.
2562@item Address
2df3850c 2563Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2564@item What
2565Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2566line number.
2567@end table
2568
2569@noindent
2570If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2571the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2572are listed after that.
2573
2574@noindent
2575@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2576number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2577convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2578the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2579listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2580
2581@noindent
2582@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2583has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2584@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2585hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2586was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2587will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2588@end table
2589
2590@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2591your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2592the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2593(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2594
2595@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2596@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2597@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2598special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2599programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2600starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2601You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2602@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2603
2604
6d2ebf8b 2605@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2606@subsection Setting watchpoints
2607
2608@cindex setting watchpoints
2609@cindex software watchpoints
2610@cindex hardware watchpoints
2611You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2612expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2613this may happen.
2614
2615Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2616hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2617program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2618times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2619catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2620culprit.)
2621
d4f3574e 2622On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2623@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2624hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2625program.
2626
2627@table @code
2628@kindex watch
2629@item watch @var{expr}
2630Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2631is written into by the program and its value changes.
2632
2633@kindex rwatch
2634@item rwatch @var{expr}
2635Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2636
2637@kindex awatch
2638@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2639Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2640by the program.
c906108c
SS
2641
2642@kindex info watchpoints
2643@item info watchpoints
2644This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2645it is the same as @code{info break}.
2646@end table
2647
2648@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2649watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2650value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2651cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2652executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2653statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2654
2655When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2656
474c8240 2657@smallexample
c906108c 2658Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2659@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2660
2661@noindent
2662if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2663
7be570e7
JM
2664Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2665hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2666value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2667every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2668that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2669hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2670will print a message like this:
2671
2672@smallexample
2673Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2674@end smallexample
2675
2676Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2677data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2678watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2679can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2680cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2681double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2682wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2683into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2684
2685If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2686to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2687Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2688time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2689able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2690warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2691
2692@smallexample
2693Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2694@end smallexample
2695
2696@noindent
2697If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2698
2699The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2700or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2701data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2702hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2703both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2704watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2705@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2706watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2707@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2708Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2709
2710If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2711any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2712kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2713
7be570e7
JM
2714@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2715(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2716they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2717which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2718being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2719and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2720rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2721way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2722@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2723
c906108c
SS
2724@quotation
2725@cindex watchpoints and threads
2726@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2727@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2728usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2729can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2730you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2731thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2732can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2733@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2734the expression.
53a5351d 2735
d4f3574e 2736@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2737@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2738have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2739watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2740single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2741change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2742confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2743software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2744when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2745watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2746@end quotation
c906108c 2747
6d2ebf8b 2748@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2749@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2750@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2751@cindex exception handlers
2752@cindex event handling
2753
2754You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2755kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2756shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2757
2758@table @code
2759@kindex catch
2760@item catch @var{event}
2761Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2762@table @code
2763@item throw
2764@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2765The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2766
2767@item catch
2768@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2769The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2770
2771@item exec
2772@kindex catch exec
2773A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2774
2775@item fork
2776@kindex catch fork
2777A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2778
2779@item vfork
2780@kindex catch vfork
2781A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2782
2783@item load
2784@itemx load @var{libname}
2785@kindex catch load
2786The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2787@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2788
2789@item unload
2790@itemx unload @var{libname}
2791@kindex catch unload
2792The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2793of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2794@end table
2795
2796@item tcatch @var{event}
2797Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2798automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2799
2800@end table
2801
2802Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2803
b37052ae 2804There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2805(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2806
2807@itemize @bullet
2808@item
2809If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2810control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2811raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2812returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2813simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2814that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2815you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2816disabled within interactive calls.
2817
2818@item
2819You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2823@end itemize
2824
2825@cindex raise exceptions
2826Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2827if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2828stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2829can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2830breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2831out where the exception was raised.
2832
2833To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2834knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2835raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2836which has the following ANSI C interface:
2837
474c8240 2838@smallexample
c906108c 2839 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2840 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2841 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2842@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2843
2844@noindent
2845To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2846unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2847(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2848
2849With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2850that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2851a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2852breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2853raised.
2854
2855
6d2ebf8b 2856@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2857@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2858
2859@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2860@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2861It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2862catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2863to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2864breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2865
2866With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2867where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2868delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2869their breakpoint numbers.
2870
2871It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2872automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2873when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2874
2875@table @code
2876@kindex clear
2877@item clear
2878Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2879selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2880the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2881breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2882
2883@item clear @var{function}
2884@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2885Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2886
2887@item clear @var{linenum}
2888@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2889Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2890
2891@cindex delete breakpoints
2892@kindex delete
41afff9a 2893@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2894@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2895Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2896ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2897breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2898confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2899@end table
2900
6d2ebf8b 2901@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2902@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2903
2904@kindex disable breakpoints
2905@kindex enable breakpoints
2906Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2907prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2908it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2909that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2910
2911You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2912the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2913or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2914@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2915catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2916
2917A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2918states of enablement:
2919
2920@itemize @bullet
2921@item
2922Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2923with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2924@item
2925Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2926@item
2927Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2928disabled.
c906108c
SS
2929@item
2930Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2931immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2932set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2933@end itemize
2934
2935You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2936watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2937
2938@table @code
2939@kindex disable breakpoints
2940@kindex disable
41afff9a 2941@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2942@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2943Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2944listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2945options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2946case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2947@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2948
2949@kindex enable breakpoints
2950@kindex enable
c5394b80 2951@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2952Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2953become effective once again in stopping your program.
2954
c5394b80 2955@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2956Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2957of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2958
c5394b80 2959@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2960Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2961deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2962@end table
2963
d4f3574e
SS
2964@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2965@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2966Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2967,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2968subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2969the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2970breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2971breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2972stepping}.)
2973
6d2ebf8b 2974@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2975@subsection Break conditions
2976@cindex conditional breakpoints
2977@cindex breakpoint conditions
2978
2979@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2980@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2981The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2982specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2983breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2984programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2985a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2986and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2987
2988This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2989situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2990when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2991by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2992@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2993
2994Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2995since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2996it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2997and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2998one.
2999
3000Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3001your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3002that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3003format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3004unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3005that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3006program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3007breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3008conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3009purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3010(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3011
3012Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3013@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3014Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3015with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3016
c906108c
SS
3017You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3018The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3019@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3020catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3021
3022@table @code
3023@kindex condition
3024@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3025Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3026watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3027breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3028@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3029@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3030syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3031referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3032symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3033prints an error message:
3034
474c8240 3035@smallexample
d4f3574e 3036No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3037@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3038
3039@noindent
c906108c
SS
3040@value{GDBN} does
3041not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3042command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3043@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3044
3045@item condition @var{bnum}
3046Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3047an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3048@end table
3049
3050@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3051A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3052breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3053useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3054count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3055is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3056therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3057ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3058the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3059value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3060your program reaches it.
3061
3062@table @code
3063@kindex ignore
3064@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3065Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3066The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3067execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3068takes no action.
3069
3070To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3071a count of zero.
3072
3073When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3074breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3075@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3076Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3077
3078If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3079condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3080@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3081
3082You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3083as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3084is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3085variables}.
3086@end table
3087
3088Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3089
3090
6d2ebf8b 3091@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3092@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3093
3094@cindex breakpoint commands
3095You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3096commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3097example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3098enable other breakpoints.
3099
3100@table @code
3101@kindex commands
3102@kindex end
3103@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3104@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3105@itemx end
3106Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3107themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3108@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3109
3110To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3111follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3112
3113With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3114breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3115recently encountered).
3116@end table
3117
3118Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3119disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3120
3121You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3122use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3123that resumes execution.
3124
3125Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3126execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3127(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3128another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3129ambiguities about which list to execute.
3130
3131@kindex silent
3132If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3133usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3134be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3135then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3136see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3137meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3138
3139The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3140print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3141breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3142
3143For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3144value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3145
474c8240 3146@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3147break foo if x>0
3148commands
3149silent
3150printf "x is %d\n",x
3151cont
3152end
474c8240 3153@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3154
3155One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3156you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3157of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3158erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3159to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3160so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3161command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3162
474c8240 3163@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3164break 403
3165commands
3166silent
3167set x = y + 4
3168cont
3169end
474c8240 3170@end smallexample
c906108c 3171
6d2ebf8b 3172@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3173@subsection Breakpoint menus
3174@cindex overloading
3175@cindex symbol overloading
3176
b37052ae 3177Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3178to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3179This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3180@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3181a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3182something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3183particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3184you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3185waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3186options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3187sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3188@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3189breakpoints.
3190
3191For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3192breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3193We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3194
3195@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3196@smallexample
3197@group
3198(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3199[0] cancel
3200[1] all
3201[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3202[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3203[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3204[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3205[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3206[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3207> 2 4 6
3208Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3209Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3210Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3211Multiple breakpoints were set.
3212Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3213 breakpoints.
3214(@value{GDBP})
3215@end group
3216@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3217
3218@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3219@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3220@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3221@c
3222@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3223@c
d4f3574e
SS
3224Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3225any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3226attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3227@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3228
474c8240 3229@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3230Cannot insert breakpoints.
3231The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3232@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233
3234When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3235
3236@enumerate
3237@item
3238Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3239
3240@item
5d161b24 3241Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3242name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3243that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3244Then start your program again.
3245
3246@item
3247Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3248linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3249to nonsharable executables.
3250@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3251@c @end ifclear
3252
d4f3574e
SS
3253A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3254hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3255
3256@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3257@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3258@smallexample
3259Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3260You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3261@end smallexample
3262
3263@noindent
3264This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3265only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3266watchpoints it needs to insert.
3267
3268When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3269hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3270
3271
6d2ebf8b 3272@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3273@section Continuing and stepping
3274
3275@cindex stepping
3276@cindex continuing
3277@cindex resuming execution
3278@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3279completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3280one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3281line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3282particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3283your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3284it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3285@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3286
3287@table @code
3288@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3289@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3290@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3291@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3292@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3293@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3294Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3295any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3296@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3297ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3298@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3299
3300The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3301stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3302@code{continue} is ignored.
3303
d4f3574e
SS
3304The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3305debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3306purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3307@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3308@end table
3309
3310To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3311(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3312calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3313different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3314
3315A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3316(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3317beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3318is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3319and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3320interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3321
3322@table @code
3323@kindex step
41afff9a 3324@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3325@item step
3326Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3327line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3328abbreviated @code{s}.
3329
3330@quotation
3331@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3332@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3333@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3334@c distinction here.
3335@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3336within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3337execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3338debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3339is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3340without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3341below.
3342@end quotation
3343
4a92d011
EZ
3344The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3345line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3346@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3347to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3348the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3349called within the line.
c906108c 3350
d4f3574e
SS
3351Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3352number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3353@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3354on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3355was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3356
3357@item step @var{count}
3358Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3359breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3360@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3361
3362@kindex next
41afff9a 3363@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3364@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3365Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3366This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3367the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3368control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3369that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3370is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3371
3372An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3373
3374
3375@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3376@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3377@c
3378@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3379@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3380@c function are executed without stopping.
3381
d4f3574e
SS
3382The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3383source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3384@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3385
b90a5f51
CF
3386@kindex set step-mode
3387@item set step-mode
3388@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3389@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3390@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3391The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3392stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3393information rather than stepping over it.
3394
4a92d011
EZ
3395This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3396machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3397want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3398
3399@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3400Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3401debug information. This is the default.
3402
c906108c
SS
3403@kindex finish
3404@item finish
3405Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3406returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3407
3408Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3409,Returning from a function}).
3410
3411@kindex until
41afff9a 3412@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3413@item until
3414@itemx u
3415Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3416current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3417stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3418command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3419automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3420than the address of the jump.
3421
3422This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3423though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3424exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3425simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3426through the next iteration.
3427
3428@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3429stack frame.
3430
3431@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3432of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3433example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3434(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3435@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3436
474c8240 3437@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3438(@value{GDBP}) f
3439#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3440206 expand_input();
3441(@value{GDBP}) until
3442195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3443@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3444
3445This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3446generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3447start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3448written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3449to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3450expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3451statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3452
3453@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3454instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3455argument.
3456
3457@item until @var{location}
3458@itemx u @var{location}
3459Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3460reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3461the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3462,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3463and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3464
3465@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3466@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3467@item stepi
96a2c332 3468@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3469@itemx si
3470Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3471
3472It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3473instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3474instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3475Display,, Automatic display}.
3476
3477An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3478
3479@need 750
3480@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3481@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3482@item nexti
96a2c332 3483@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3484@itemx ni
3485Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3486proceed until the function returns.
3487
3488An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3489@end table
3490
6d2ebf8b 3491@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3492@section Signals
3493@cindex signals
3494
3495A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3496operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3497kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3498signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3499@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3500memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3501the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3502requested an alarm).
3503
3504@cindex fatal signals
3505Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3506functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3507errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3508program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3509@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3510fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3511
3512@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3513program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3514signal.
3515
3516@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3517Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3518@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3519(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3520but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3521You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3522
3523@table @code
3524@kindex info signals
3525@item info signals
96a2c332 3526@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3527Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3528handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3529the defined types of signals.
3530
d4f3574e 3531@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3532
3533@kindex handle
3534@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3535Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3536can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3537@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3538@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3539known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3540@end table
3541
3542@c @group
3543The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3544Their full names are:
3545
3546@table @code
3547@item nostop
3548@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3549still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3550
3551@item stop
3552@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3553the @code{print} keyword as well.
3554
3555@item print
3556@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3557
3558@item noprint
3559@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3560implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3561
3562@item pass
5ece1a18 3563@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3564@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3565can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3566and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3567
3568@item nopass
5ece1a18 3569@itemx ignore
c906108c 3570@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3571@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3572@end table
3573@c @end group
3574
d4f3574e
SS
3575When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3576program until you
c906108c
SS
3577continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3578effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3579after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3580command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3581program sees that signal when you continue.
3582
24f93129
EZ
3583The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3584non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3585@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3586erroneous signals.
3587
c906108c
SS
3588You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3589seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3590or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3591due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3592values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3593execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3594a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3595you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3596program a signal}.
c906108c 3597
6d2ebf8b 3598@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3599@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3600
3601When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3602programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3603breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3604
3605@table @code
3606@cindex breakpoints and threads
3607@cindex thread breakpoints
3608@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3609@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3610@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3611@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3612writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3613
3614Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3615to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3616particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3617numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3618column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3619
3620If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3621breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3622program.
3623
3624You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3625well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3626breakpoint condition, like this:
3627
3628@smallexample
2df3850c 3629(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3630@end smallexample
3631
3632@end table
3633
3634@cindex stopped threads
3635@cindex threads, stopped
3636Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3637@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3638allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3639switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3640underfoot.
3641
3642@cindex continuing threads
3643@cindex threads, continuing
3644Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3645executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3646like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3647
3648In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3649Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3650system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3651execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3652single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3653statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3654stops.
3655
3656You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3657continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3658thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3659first thread completes whatever you requested.
3660
3661On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3662thread to run.
3663
3664@table @code
3665@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3666Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3667locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3668current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3669mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3670``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3671stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3672when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3673function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3674like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3675thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3676@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3677
3678@item show scheduler-locking
3679Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3680@end table
3681
c906108c 3682
6d2ebf8b 3683@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3684@chapter Examining the Stack
3685
3686When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3687stopped and how it got there.
3688
3689@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3690Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3691is generated.
3692That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3693the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3694and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3695The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3696The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3697stack}.
3698
3699When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3700stack allow you to see all of this information.
3701
3702@cindex selected frame
3703One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3704@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3705particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3706your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3707special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3708interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3709
3710When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3711currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3712@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3713
3714@menu
3715* Frames:: Stack frames
3716* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3717* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3718* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3719
3720@end menu
3721
6d2ebf8b 3722@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3723@section Stack frames
3724
d4f3574e 3725@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3726@cindex stack frame
3727The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3728frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3729with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3730to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3731which the function is executing.
3732
3733@cindex initial frame
3734@cindex outermost frame
3735@cindex innermost frame
3736When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3737function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3738@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3739made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3740is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3741the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3742actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3743recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3744
3745@cindex frame pointer
3746Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3747stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3748kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3749address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3750in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3751going on in that frame.
3752
3753@cindex frame number
3754@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3755zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3756and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3757they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3758frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3759
6d2ebf8b
SS
3760@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3761@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3762@cindex frameless execution
3763Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3764without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3765@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3766@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3767@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3768generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3769This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3770the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3771with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3772has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3773it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3774correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3775no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3776
3777@table @code
d4f3574e 3778@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3779@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3780@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3781The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3782and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3783address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3784@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3785
3786@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3787@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3788@item select-frame
3789The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3790to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3791@code{frame}.
3792@end table
3793
6d2ebf8b 3794@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3795@section Backtraces
3796
3797@cindex backtraces
3798@cindex tracebacks
3799@cindex stack traces
3800A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3801line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3802frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3803stack.
3804
3805@table @code
3806@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3807@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3808@item backtrace
3809@itemx bt
3810Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3811frames in the stack.
3812
3813You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3814character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3815
3816@item backtrace @var{n}
3817@itemx bt @var{n}
3818Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3819
3820@item backtrace -@var{n}
3821@itemx bt -@var{n}
3822Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3823@end table
3824
3825@kindex where
3826@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3827@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3828The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3829are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3830
3831Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3832The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3833print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3834line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3835counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3836line number.
3837
3838Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3839@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3840
3841@smallexample
3842@group
5d161b24 3843#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3844 at builtin.c:993
3845#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3846#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3847 at macro.c:71
3848(More stack frames follow...)
3849@end group
3850@end smallexample
3851
3852@noindent
3853The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3854value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3855code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3856
6d2ebf8b 3857@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3858@section Selecting a frame
3859
3860Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3861whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3862selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3863of the stack frame just selected.
3864
3865@table @code
d4f3574e 3866@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3867@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3868@item frame @var{n}
3869@itemx f @var{n}
3870Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3871(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3872innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3873@code{main}.
3874
3875@item frame @var{addr}
3876@itemx f @var{addr}
3877Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3878chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3879impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3880addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3881switches between them.
3882
c906108c
SS
3883On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3884select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3885
3886On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3887pointer and a program counter.
3888
3889On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3890pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3891@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3892@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3893@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3894
3895@kindex up
3896@item up @var{n}
3897Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3898advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3899that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3900
3901@kindex down
41afff9a 3902@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3903@item down @var{n}
3904Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3905advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3906that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3907abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3908@end table
3909
3910All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3911frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3912arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3913frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3914
3915@need 1000
3916For example:
3917
3918@smallexample
3919@group
3920(@value{GDBP}) up
3921#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3922 at env.c:10
392310 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3924@end group
3925@end smallexample
3926
3927After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3928prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3929@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3930
3931@table @code
3932@kindex down-silently
3933@kindex up-silently
3934@item up-silently @var{n}
3935@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3936These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3937respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3938causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3939in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3940distracting.
3941@end table
3942
6d2ebf8b 3943@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3944@section Information about a frame
3945
3946There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3947stack frame.
3948
3949@table @code
3950@item frame
3951@itemx f
3952When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3953frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3954selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3955argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3956@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3957
3958@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3959@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3960@item info frame
3961@itemx info f
3962This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3963including:
3964
3965@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3966@item
3967the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3968@item
3969the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3970@item
3971the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3972@item
3973the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3974@item
3975the address of the frame's arguments
3976@item
d4f3574e
SS
3977the address of the frame's local variables
3978@item
c906108c
SS
3979the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3980@item
3981which registers were saved in the frame
3982@end itemize
3983
3984@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3985something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3986the usual conventions.
3987
3988@item info frame @var{addr}
3989@itemx info f @var{addr}
3990Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3991selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3992command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3993architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3994@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3995
3996@kindex info args
3997@item info args
3998Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3999
4000@item info locals
4001@kindex info locals
4002Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4003line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4004accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4005
c906108c 4006@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4007@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4008@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4009@item info catch
4010Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4011current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4012exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4013@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4014@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4015
c906108c
SS
4016@end table
4017
c906108c 4018
6d2ebf8b 4019@node Source
c906108c
SS
4020@chapter Examining Source Files
4021
4022@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4023information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4024used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4025the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4026(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4027execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4028source files by explicit command.
4029
7a292a7a 4030If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4031prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4032@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4033
4034@menu
4035* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 4036* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4037* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4038* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4039@end menu
4040
6d2ebf8b 4041@node List
c906108c
SS
4042@section Printing source lines
4043
4044@kindex list
41afff9a 4045@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4046To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4047(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4048There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4049
4050Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4051
4052@table @code
4053@item list @var{linenum}
4054Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4055current source file.
4056
4057@item list @var{function}
4058Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4059@var{function}.
4060
4061@item list
4062Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4063@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4064printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4065as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4066Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4067
4068@item list -
4069Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4070@end table
4071
4072By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4073the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4074
4075@table @code
4076@kindex set listsize
4077@item set listsize @var{count}
4078Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4079the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4080
4081@kindex show listsize
4082@item show listsize
4083Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4084@end table
4085
4086Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4087so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4088than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4089argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4090each repetition moves up in the source file.
4091
4092@cindex linespec
4093In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4094@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4095of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4096Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4097
4098@table @code
4099@item list @var{linespec}
4100Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4101
4102@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4103Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4104linespecs.
4105
4106@item list ,@var{last}
4107Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4108
4109@item list @var{first},
4110Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4111
4112@item list +
4113Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4114
4115@item list -
4116Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4117
4118@item list
4119As described in the preceding table.
4120@end table
4121
4122Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4123kinds of linespec.
4124
4125@table @code
4126@item @var{number}
4127Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4128When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4129the same source file as the first linespec.
4130
4131@item +@var{offset}
4132Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4133When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4134two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4135first linespec.
4136
4137@item -@var{offset}
4138Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4139
4140@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4141Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4142
4143@item @var{function}
4144Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4145For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4146
4147@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4148Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4149function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4150file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4151identically named functions in different source files.
4152
4153@item *@var{address}
4154Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4155@var{address} may be any expression.
4156@end table
4157
6d2ebf8b 4158@node Search
c906108c
SS
4159@section Searching source files
4160@cindex searching
4161@kindex reverse-search
4162
4163There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4164regular expression.
4165
4166@table @code
4167@kindex search
4168@kindex forward-search
4169@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4170@itemx search @var{regexp}
4171The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4172starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4173@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4174synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4175@code{fo}.
4176
4177@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4178The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4179with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4180for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4181this command as @code{rev}.
4182@end table
c906108c 4183
6d2ebf8b 4184@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4185@section Specifying source directories
4186
4187@cindex source path
4188@cindex directories for source files
4189Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4190files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4191the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4192session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4193this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4194it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4195in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4196the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4197the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4198path.
4199
4200If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4201object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4202too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4203compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4204last resort.
4205
4206Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4207any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4208each line is in the file.
4209
4210@kindex directory
4211@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4212When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4213and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4214To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4215
4216@table @code
4217@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4218@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4219Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4220directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4221(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4222part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4223whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4224path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4225
4226@kindex cdir
4227@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4228@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4229@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4230@cindex compilation directory
4231@cindex current directory
4232@cindex working directory
4233@cindex directory, current
4234@cindex directory, compilation
4235You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4236directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4237working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4238tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4239session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4240directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4241
4242@item directory
4243Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4244
4245@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4246@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4247
4248@item show directories
4249@kindex show directories
4250Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4251@end table
4252
4253If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4254interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4255versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4256
4257@enumerate
4258@item
4259Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4260
4261@item
4262Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4263directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4264directories in one command.
4265@end enumerate
4266
6d2ebf8b 4267@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4268@section Source and machine code
4269
4270You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4271addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4272a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4273mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4274line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4275well as hex.
4276
4277@table @code
4278@kindex info line
4279@item info line @var{linespec}
4280Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4281source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4282the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4283source lines}).
4284@end table
4285
4286For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4287the object code for the first line of function
4288@code{m4_changequote}:
4289
d4f3574e
SS
4290@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4291@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4292@smallexample
96a2c332 4293(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4294Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4295@end smallexample
4296
4297@noindent
4298We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4299@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4300@smallexample
4301(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4302Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4303@end smallexample
4304
4305@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4306@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4307After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4308is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4309sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4310,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4311convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4312variables}).
4313
4314@table @code
4315@kindex disassemble
4316@cindex assembly instructions
4317@cindex instructions, assembly
4318@cindex machine instructions
4319@cindex listing machine instructions
4320@item disassemble
4321This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4322instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4323program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4324command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4325surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4326(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4327@end table
4328
c906108c
SS
4329The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4330HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4331
4332@smallexample
4333(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4334Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
43350x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
43360x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
43370x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
43380x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
43390x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
43400x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
43410x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
43420x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4343End of assembler dump.
4344@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4345
4346Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4347mnemonics or other syntax.
4348
4349@table @code
d4f3574e 4350@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4351@cindex assembly instructions
4352@cindex instructions, assembly
4353@cindex machine instructions
4354@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4355@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4356@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4357@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4358Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4359program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4360
4361Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4362can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4363The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4364assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4365@end table
4366
4367
6d2ebf8b 4368@node Data
c906108c
SS
4369@chapter Examining Data
4370
4371@cindex printing data
4372@cindex examining data
4373@kindex print
4374@kindex inspect
4375@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4376@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4377@c different window or something like that.
4378The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4379command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4380evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4381program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4382Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4383
4384@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4385@item print @var{expr}
4386@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4387@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4388value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4389you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4390@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4391formats}.
4392
4393@item print
4394@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4395If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4396@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4397conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4398@end table
4399
4400A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4401It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4402specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4403
7a292a7a 4404If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4405fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4406command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4407Table}.
c906108c
SS
4408
4409@menu
4410* Expressions:: Expressions
4411* Variables:: Program variables
4412* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4413* Output Formats:: Output formats
4414* Memory:: Examining memory
4415* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4416* Print Settings:: Print settings
4417* Value History:: Value history
4418* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4419* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4420* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4421* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4422* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
c906108c
SS
4423@end menu
4424
6d2ebf8b 4425@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4426@section Expressions
4427
4428@cindex expressions
4429@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4430compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4431by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4432@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4433casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4434you compiled your program to include this information; see
4435@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4436
d4f3574e
SS
4437@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4438the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4439you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4440memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4441
c906108c
SS
4442Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4443this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4444Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4445languages.
4446
4447In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4448expressions regardless of your programming language.
4449
4450Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4451useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4452at that address in memory.
4453@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4454
4455@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4456to programming languages:
4457
4458@table @code
4459@item @@
4460@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4461@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4462
4463@item ::
4464@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4465function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4466
4467@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4468@cindex type casting memory
4469@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4470@cindex casts, to view memory
4471@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4472Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4473memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4474pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4475a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4476normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4477@end table
4478
6d2ebf8b 4479@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4480@section Program variables
4481
4482The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4483in your program.
4484
4485Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4486(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4487
4488@itemize @bullet
4489@item
4490global (or file-static)
4491@end itemize
4492
5d161b24 4493@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4494
4495@itemize @bullet
4496@item
4497visible according to the scope rules of the
4498programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4499@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4500
4501@noindent This means that in the function
4502
474c8240 4503@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4504foo (a)
4505 int a;
4506@{
4507 bar (a);
4508 @{
4509 int b = test ();
4510 bar (b);
4511 @}
4512@}
474c8240 4513@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4514
4515@noindent
4516you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4517executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4518examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4519the block where @code{b} is declared.
4520
4521@cindex variable name conflict
4522There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4523scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4524in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4525function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4526happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4527you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4528using the colon-colon notation:
4529
d4f3574e 4530@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4531@iftex
4532@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4533@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4534@end iftex
474c8240 4535@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4536@var{file}::@var{variable}
4537@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4538@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4539
4540@noindent
4541Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4542static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4543make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4544to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4545
474c8240 4546@smallexample
c906108c 4547(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4548@end smallexample
c906108c 4549
b37052ae 4550@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4551This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4552use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4553scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4554@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4555@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4556
4557@cindex wrong values
4558@cindex variable values, wrong
4559@quotation
4560@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4561wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4562scope, and just before exit.
4563@end quotation
4564You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4565This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4566set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4567stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4568values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4569also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4570after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4571variable definitions may be gone.
4572
4573This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4574To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4575when compiling.
4576
d4f3574e
SS
4577@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4578Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4579unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4580opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4581offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4582might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4583happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4584
474c8240 4585@smallexample
d4f3574e 4586No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4587@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4588
4589To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4590different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4591formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4592supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4593in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4594to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4595debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4596Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4597information.
4598
4599
6d2ebf8b 4600@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4601@section Artificial arrays
4602
4603@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4604@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4605It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4606same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4607dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4608program.
4609
4610You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4611@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4612operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4613and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4614of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4615the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4616argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4617following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4618example. If a program says
4619
474c8240 4620@smallexample
c906108c 4621int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4622@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4623
4624@noindent
4625you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4626
474c8240 4627@smallexample
c906108c 4628p *array@@len
474c8240 4629@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4630
4631The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4632with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4633subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4634Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4635(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4636
4637Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4638This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4639The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4640@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4641(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4642$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4643@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4644
4645As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4646@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4647the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4648@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4649(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4650$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4651@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4652
4653Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4654moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4655actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4656of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4657to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4658variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4659interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4660instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4661structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4662in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4663
474c8240 4664@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4665set $i = 0
4666p dtab[$i++]->fv
4667@key{RET}
4668@key{RET}
4669@dots{}
474c8240 4670@end smallexample
c906108c 4671
6d2ebf8b 4672@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4673@section Output formats
4674
4675@cindex formatted output
4676@cindex output formats
4677By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4678this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4679in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4680at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4681these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4682
4683The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4684already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4685@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4686letters supported are:
4687
4688@table @code
4689@item x
4690Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4691hexadecimal.
4692
4693@item d
4694Print as integer in signed decimal.
4695
4696@item u
4697Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4698
4699@item o
4700Print as integer in octal.
4701
4702@item t
4703Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4704@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4705used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4706see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4707
4708@item a
4709@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4710@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4711Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4712the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4713where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4714
474c8240 4715@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4716(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4717$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4718@end smallexample
c906108c 4719
3d67e040
EZ
4720@noindent
4721The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4722@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4723
c906108c
SS
4724@item c
4725Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4726
4727@item f
4728Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4729using typical floating point syntax.
4730@end table
4731
4732For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4733
474c8240 4734@smallexample
c906108c 4735p/x $pc
474c8240 4736@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4737
4738@noindent
4739Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4740names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4741
4742To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4743you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4744expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4745
6d2ebf8b 4746@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4747@section Examining memory
4748
4749You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4750any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4751
4752@cindex examining memory
4753@table @code
41afff9a 4754@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4755@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4756@itemx x @var{addr}
4757@itemx x
4758Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4759@end table
4760
4761@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4762much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4763expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4764If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4765Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4766
4767@table @r
4768@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4769The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4770how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4771@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4772@c 4.1.2.
4773
4774@item @var{f}, the display format
4775The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4776@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4777The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4778The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4779
4780@item @var{u}, the unit size
4781The unit size is any of
4782
4783@table @code
4784@item b
4785Bytes.
4786@item h
4787Halfwords (two bytes).
4788@item w
4789Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4790@item g
4791Giant words (eight bytes).
4792@end table
4793
4794Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4795default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4796@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4797
4798@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4799@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4800memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4801it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4802@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4803@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4804other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4805the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4806starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4807a value from memory).
4808@end table
4809
4810For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4811(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4812starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4813words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4814@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4815
4816Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4817letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4818unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4819specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4820(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4821
4822Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4823and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4824@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4825including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4826alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4827Code,,Source and machine code}.
4828
4829All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4830easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4831you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4832instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4833with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4834the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4835for successive uses of @code{x}.
4836
4837@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4838The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4839in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4840would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4841subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4842@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4843examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4844@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4845the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4846
4847If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4848are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4849address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4850
6d2ebf8b 4851@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4852@section Automatic display
4853@cindex automatic display
4854@cindex display of expressions
4855
4856If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4857(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4858display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4859Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4860to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4861The automatic display looks like this:
4862
474c8240 4863@smallexample
c906108c
SS
48642: foo = 38
48653: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4866@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4867
4868@noindent
4869This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4870displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4871specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4872whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4873format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4874or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4875supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4876
4877@table @code
4878@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4879@item display @var{expr}
4880Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4881each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4882
4883@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4884
d4f3574e 4885@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4886For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4887count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4888arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4889@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4890
4891@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4892For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4893number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4894be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4895doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4896@end table
4897
4898For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4899instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4900is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4901
4902@table @code
4903@kindex delete display
4904@kindex undisplay
4905@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4906@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4907Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4908
4909@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4910(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4911
4912@kindex disable display
4913@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4914Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4915item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4916enabled again later.
4917
4918@kindex enable display
4919@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4920Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4921again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4922
4923@item display
4924Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4925done when your program stops.
4926
4927@kindex info display
4928@item info display
4929Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4930automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4931values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4932It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4933because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4934@end table
4935
4936If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4937sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4938expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4939variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4940@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4941@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4942continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4943there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4944automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4945is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4946
6d2ebf8b 4947@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4948@section Print settings
4949
4950@cindex format options
4951@cindex print settings
4952@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4953and symbols are printed.
4954
4955@noindent
4956These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4957
4958@table @code
4959@kindex set print address
4960@item set print address
4961@itemx set print address on
4962@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4963traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4964even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4965is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4966@code{set print address on}:
4967
4968@smallexample
4969@group
4970(@value{GDBP}) f
4971#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4972 at input.c:530
4973530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4974@end group
4975@end smallexample
4976
4977@item set print address off
4978Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4979this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4980
4981@smallexample
4982@group
4983(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4984(@value{GDBP}) f
4985#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4986530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4987@end group
4988@end smallexample
4989
4990You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4991dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4992@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4993all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4994
4995@kindex show print address
4996@item show print address
4997Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4998@end table
4999
5000When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5001closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5002identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5003source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5004@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5005you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5006it prints a symbolic address:
5007
5008@table @code
5009@kindex set print symbol-filename
5010@item set print symbol-filename on
5011Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5012symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5013
5014@item set print symbol-filename off
5015Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5016default.
5017
5018@kindex show print symbol-filename
5019@item show print symbol-filename
5020Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5021line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5022@end table
5023
5024Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5025numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5026number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5027
5028Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5029printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5030
5031@table @code
5032@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5033@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5034Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5035offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5036@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5037to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5038
5039@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5040@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5041Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5042symbolic address.
5043@end table
5044
5045@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5046@cindex pointer, finding referent
5047If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5048@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5049and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5050@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5051For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5052at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5053
474c8240 5054@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5055(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5056(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5057$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5058@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5059
5060@quotation
5061@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5062does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5063the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5064@end quotation
5065
5066Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5067
5068@table @code
5069@kindex set print array
5070@item set print array
5071@itemx set print array on
5072Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5073but uses more space. The default is off.
5074
5075@item set print array off
5076Return to compressed format for arrays.
5077
5078@kindex show print array
5079@item show print array
5080Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5081arrays.
5082
5083@kindex set print elements
5084@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5085Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5086If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5087printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5088This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5089When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5090Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5091
5092@kindex show print elements
5093@item show print elements
5094Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5095If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5096
5097@kindex set print null-stop
5098@item set print null-stop
5099Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5100@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5101contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5102The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5103
5104@kindex set print pretty
5105@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5106Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5107per line, like this:
5108
5109@smallexample
5110@group
5111$1 = @{
5112 next = 0x0,
5113 flags = @{
5114 sweet = 1,
5115 sour = 1
5116 @},
5117 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5118@}
5119@end group
5120@end smallexample
5121
5122@item set print pretty off
5123Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5124
5125@smallexample
5126@group
5127$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5128meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5129@end group
5130@end smallexample
5131
5132@noindent
5133This is the default format.
5134
5135@kindex show print pretty
5136@item show print pretty
5137Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5138
5139@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5140@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5141Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5142@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5143character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5144best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5145high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5146
5147@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5148Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5149international character sets, and is the default.
5150
5151@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5152@item show print sevenbit-strings
5153Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5154
5155@kindex set print union
5156@item set print union on
5d161b24 5157Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5158is the default setting.
5159
5160@item set print union off
5161Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5162
5163@kindex show print union
5164@item show print union
5165Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5166structures.
5167
5168For example, given the declarations
5169
5170@smallexample
5171typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5172typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5173typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5174 Bug_forms;
5175
5176struct thing @{
5177 Species it;
5178 union @{
5179 Tree_forms tree;
5180 Bug_forms bug;
5181 @} form;
5182@};
5183
5184struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5185@end smallexample
5186
5187@noindent
5188with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5189
5190@smallexample
5191$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5192@end smallexample
5193
5194@noindent
5195and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5196
5197@smallexample
5198$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5199@end smallexample
5200@end table
5201
c906108c
SS
5202@need 1000
5203@noindent
b37052ae 5204These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5205
5206@table @code
5207@cindex demangling
5208@kindex set print demangle
5209@item set print demangle
5210@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5211Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5212(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5213linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5214
5215@kindex show print demangle
5216@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5217Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5218
5219@kindex set print asm-demangle
5220@item set print asm-demangle
5221@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5222Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5223in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5224The default is off.
5225
5226@kindex show print asm-demangle
5227@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5228Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5229or demangled form.
5230
5231@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5232@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5233@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5234@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5235Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5236represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5237
5238@table @code
5239@item auto
5240Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5241
5242@item gnu
b37052ae 5243Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5244This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5245
5246@item hp
b37052ae 5247Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5248
5249@item lucid
b37052ae 5250Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5251
5252@item arm
b37052ae 5253Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5254@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5255debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5256require further enhancement to permit that.
5257
5258@end table
5259If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5260
5261@kindex show demangle-style
5262@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5263Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5264
5265@kindex set print object
5266@item set print object
5267@itemx set print object on
5268When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5269(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5270the virtual function table.
5271
5272@item set print object off
5273Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5274virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5275
5276@kindex show print object
5277@item show print object
5278Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5279
5280@kindex set print static-members
5281@item set print static-members
5282@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5283Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5284
5285@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5286Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5287
5288@kindex show print static-members
5289@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5290Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5291
5292@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5293@kindex set print vtbl
5294@item set print vtbl
5295@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5296Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5297(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5298ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5299
5300@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5301Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5302
5303@kindex show print vtbl
5304@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5305Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5306@end table
c906108c 5307
6d2ebf8b 5308@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5309@section Value history
5310
5311@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5312Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5313@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5314Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5315(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5316When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5317since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5318symbol table.
5319
5320@cindex @code{$}
5321@cindex @code{$$}
5322@cindex history number
5323The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5324refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5325@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5326printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5327history number.
5328
5329To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5330history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5331remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5332the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5333@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5334is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5335@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5336
5337For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5338want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5339
474c8240 5340@smallexample
c906108c 5341p *$
474c8240 5342@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5343
5344If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5345to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5346
474c8240 5347@smallexample
c906108c 5348p *$.next
474c8240 5349@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5350
5351@noindent
5352You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5353command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5354
5355Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5356@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5357
474c8240 5358@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5359print x
5360set x=5
474c8240 5361@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5362
5363@noindent
5364then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5365remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5366
5367@table @code
5368@kindex show values
5369@item show values
5370Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5371This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5372values} does not change the history.
5373
5374@item show values @var{n}
5375Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5376
5377@item show values +
5378Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5379values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5380@end table
5381
5382Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5383same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5384
6d2ebf8b 5385@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5386@section Convenience variables
5387
5388@cindex convenience variables
5389@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5390@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5391exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5392setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5393of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5394
5395Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5396@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5397the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5398(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5399by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5400
5401You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5402expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5403For example:
5404
474c8240 5405@smallexample
c906108c 5406set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5407@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5408
5409@noindent
5410would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5411@code{object_ptr}.
5412
5413Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5414value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5415value with another assignment at any time.
5416
5417Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5418variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5419that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5420variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5421
5422@table @code
5423@kindex show convenience
5424@item show convenience
5425Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5426Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5427@end table
5428
5429One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5430incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5431a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5432
474c8240 5433@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5434set $i = 0
5435print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5436@end smallexample
c906108c 5437
d4f3574e
SS
5438@noindent
5439Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5440
5441Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5442values likely to be useful.
5443
5444@table @code
41afff9a 5445@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5446@item $_
5447The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5448the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5449commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5450set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5451and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5452except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5453to the type of @code{$__}.
5454
41afff9a 5455@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5456@item $__
5457The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5458to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5459to match the format in which the data was printed.
5460
5461@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5462@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5463The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5464the program being debugged terminates.
5465@end table
5466
53a5351d
JM
5467On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5468begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5469name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5470
6d2ebf8b 5471@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5472@section Registers
5473
5474@cindex registers
5475You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5476with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5477for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5478your machine.
5479
5480@table @code
5481@kindex info registers
5482@item info registers
5483Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5484registers (in the selected stack frame).
5485
5486@kindex info all-registers
5487@cindex floating point registers
5488@item info all-registers
5489Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5490registers.
5491
5492@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5493Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5494As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5495the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5496the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5497@end table
5498
5499@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5500expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5501architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5502@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5503the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5504pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5505register that contains the processor status. For example,
5506you could print the program counter in hex with
5507
474c8240 5508@smallexample
c906108c 5509p/x $pc
474c8240 5510@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5511
5512@noindent
5513or print the instruction to be executed next with
5514
474c8240 5515@smallexample
c906108c 5516x/i $pc
474c8240 5517@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5518
5519@noindent
5520or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5521one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5522memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5523stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5524stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5525regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5526see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5527
474c8240 5528@smallexample
c906108c 5529set $sp += 4
474c8240 5530@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5531
5532Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5533your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5534so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5535shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5536registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5537can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5538is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5539
5540@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5541integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5542special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5543registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5544to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5545(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5546@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5547
5548Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5549means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5550the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5551sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5552coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5553programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5554cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5555that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5556prints the data in both formats.
5557
5558Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5559(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5560value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5561were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5562true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5563frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5564
5565However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5566code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5567@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5568frame makes no difference.
5569
6d2ebf8b 5570@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5571@section Floating point hardware
5572@cindex floating point
5573
5574Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5575you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5576
5577@table @code
5578@kindex info float
5579@item info float
5580Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5581point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5582floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5583the ARM and x86 machines.
5584@end table
c906108c 5585
29e57380 5586@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5587@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5588@cindex memory region attributes
5589
5590@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5591required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5592to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5593use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5594
5595Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5596memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5597accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5598been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5599all memory.
5600
5601When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5602to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5603
5604@table @code
5605@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5606@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5607Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5608attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5609special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5610(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5611
5612@kindex delete mem
5613@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5614Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5615
5616@kindex disable mem
5617@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5618Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5619A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5620It may be enabled again later.
5621
5622@kindex enable mem
5623@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5624Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5625
5626@kindex info mem
5627@item info mem
5628Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5629for each region.
5630
5631@table @emph
5632@item Memory Region Number
5633@item Enabled or Disabled.
5634Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5635Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5636
5637@item Lo Address
5638The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5639
5640@item Hi Address
5641The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5642
5643@item Attributes
5644The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5645@end table
5646@end table
5647
5648
5649@subsection Attributes
5650
5651@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5652The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5653write accesses to a memory region.
5654
5655While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5656memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5657etc. from accessing memory.
5658
5659@table @code
5660@item ro
5661Memory is read only.
5662@item wo
5663Memory is write only.
5664@item rw
6ca652b0 5665Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5666@end table
5667
5668@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5669The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5670accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5671require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5672specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5673
5674@table @code
5675@item 8
5676Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5677@item 16
5678Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5679@item 32
5680Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5681@item 64
5682Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5683@end table
5684
5685@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5686@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5687@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5688@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5689@c
5690@c @table @code
5691@c @item hwbreak
5692@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5693@c @item swbreak (default)
5694@c @end table
5695
5696@subsubsection Data Cache
5697The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5698memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5699protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5700does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5701registers.
5702
5703@table @code
5704@item cache
5705Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5706@item nocache
5707Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5708@end table
5709
5710@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5711@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5712@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5713@c
5714@c @table @code
5715@c @item verify
5716@c @item noverify (default)
5717@c @end table
5718
16d9dec6
MS
5719@node Dump/Restore Files
5720@section Copy between memory and a file
5721@cindex dump/restore files
5722@cindex append data to a file
5723@cindex dump data to a file
5724@cindex restore data from a file
5725@kindex dump
5726@kindex append
5727@kindex restore
5728
5729The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5730for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5731into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5732file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5733intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5734
5735@table @code
5736@kindex dump binary
5737@kindex append binary
5738@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5739Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5740raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5741
5742@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5743Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5744raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5745
5746@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5747Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5748
5749@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5750Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5751
5752@kindex dump ihex
5753@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5754Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5755intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5756
5757@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5758Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5759
5760@kindex dump srec
5761@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5762Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5763srec format file @var{filename}.
5764
5765@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5766Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5767
5768@kindex dump tekhex
5769@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5770Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5771tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5772
5773@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5774Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5775
42f9b0a5 5776@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5777Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5778command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5779raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5780@var{binary} after the filename.
5781
5782If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5783contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5784they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5785a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5786from that location.
5787
5788If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5789file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5790These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5791the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5792
5793@end table
5794
e2e0bcd1
JB
5795@node Macros
5796@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
5797
5798Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
5799``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
5800@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
5801the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
5802where it was defined.
5803
5804You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
5805with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
5806include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
5807with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
5808
5809A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
5810and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
5811points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
5812no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
5813uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
5814@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
5815see @ref{List}.
5816
5817At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
5818token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
5819variable-arity macros.
5820
5821Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
5822macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
5823the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
5824
5825@table @code
5826
5827@kindex macro expand
5828@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
5829@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
5830@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
5831@item macro expand @var{expression}
5832@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
5833Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
5834@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
5835not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
5836it can be any string of tokens.
5837
5838@kindex macro expand-once
5839@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
5840@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
5841@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
5842expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
5843@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
5844left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
5845particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
5846expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
5847parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
5848can be any string of tokens.
5849
475b0867 5850@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
5851@cindex macro definition, showing
5852@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 5853@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
5854Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
5855source location where that definition was established.
5856
5857@kindex macro define
5858@cindex user-defined macros
5859@cindex defining macros interactively
5860@cindex macros, user-defined
5861@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
5862@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
5863@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
5864preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
5865by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
5866command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
5867second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
5868given in @var{arglist}.
5869
5870A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
5871evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
5872undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
5873definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
5874well as any previous user-supplied definition.
5875
5876@kindex macro undef
5877@item macro undef @var{macro}
5878@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
5879definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
5880definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
5881above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
5882debugged.
5883
5884@end table
5885
5886@cindex macros, example of debugging with
5887Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
5888show our source files:
5889
5890@smallexample
5891$ cat sample.c
5892#include <stdio.h>
5893#include "sample.h"
5894
5895#define M 42
5896#define ADD(x) (M + x)
5897
5898main ()
5899@{
5900#define N 28
5901 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
5902#undef N
5903 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
5904#define N 1729
5905 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
5906@}
5907$ cat sample.h
5908#define Q <
5909$
5910@end smallexample
5911
5912Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
5913We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
5914compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
5915information.
5916
5917@smallexample
5918$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
5919$
5920@end smallexample
5921
5922Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
5923
5924@smallexample
5925$ gdb -nw sample
5926GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
5927Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5928GDB is free software, @dots{}
5929(gdb)
5930@end smallexample
5931
5932We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
5933program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
5934to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
5935
5936@smallexample
5937(gdb) list main
59383
59394 #define M 42
59405 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
59416
59427 main ()
59438 @{
59449 #define N 28
594510 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
594611 #undef N
594712 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 5948(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
5949Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
5950#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 5951(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
5952Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
5953 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
5954#define Q <
5955(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
5956expands to: (42 + 1)
5957(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
5958expands to: once (M + 1)
5959(gdb)
5960@end smallexample
5961
5962In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
5963the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
5964@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
5965which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
5966
5967Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
5968the source line of the current stack frame:
5969
5970@smallexample
5971(gdb) break main
5972Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
5973(gdb) run
5974Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
5975
5976Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
597710 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
5978(gdb)
5979@end smallexample
5980
5981At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
5982
5983@smallexample
475b0867 5984(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
5985Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
5986#define N 28
5987(gdb) macro expand N Q M
5988expands to: 28 < 42
5989(gdb) print N Q M
5990$1 = 1
5991(gdb)
5992@end smallexample
5993
5994As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
5995give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
5996thereof) in force at each point:
5997
5998@smallexample
5999(gdb) next
6000Hello, world!
600112 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6002(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6003The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6004at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6005(gdb) next
6006We're so creative.
600714 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6008(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6009Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6010#define N 1729
6011(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6012expands to: 1729 < 42
6013(gdb) print N Q M
6014$2 = 0
6015(gdb)
6016@end smallexample
6017
6018
b37052ae
EZ
6019@node Tracepoints
6020@chapter Tracepoints
6021@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6022@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6023
6024@cindex tracepoints
6025In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6026the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6027anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6028depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6029might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6030fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6031to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6032
6033Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6034specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6035arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6036Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6037those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6038expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6039for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6040a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6041in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6042values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6043unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6044
6045The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6046targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6047to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6048stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6049tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6050
6051This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6052
6053@menu
6054* Set Tracepoints::
6055* Analyze Collected Data::
6056* Tracepoint Variables::
6057@end menu
6058
6059@node Set Tracepoints
6060@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6061
6062Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6063tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6064tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6065breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6066one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6067tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6068work on.
6069
6070For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6071of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6072it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6073local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6074commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6075tracepoint was hit.
6076
6077This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6078conditions and actions.
6079
6080@menu
6081* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6082* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6083* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6084* Tracepoint Actions::
6085* Listing Tracepoints::
6086* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6087@end menu
6088
6089@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6090@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6091
6092@table @code
6093@cindex set tracepoint
6094@kindex trace
6095@item trace
6096The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6097Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6098the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6099defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6100debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6101program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6102doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6103cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6104running.
6105
6106Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6107
6108@smallexample
6109(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6110
6111(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6112
6113(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6114
6115(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6116
6117(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6118@end smallexample
6119
6120@noindent
6121You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6122
6123@vindex $tpnum
6124@cindex last tracepoint number
6125@cindex recent tracepoint number
6126@cindex tracepoint number
6127The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6128of the most recently set tracepoint.
6129
6130@kindex delete tracepoint
6131@cindex tracepoint deletion
6132@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6133Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6134default is to delete all tracepoints.
6135
6136Examples:
6137
6138@smallexample
6139(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6140
6141(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6142@end smallexample
6143
6144@noindent
6145You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6146@end table
6147
6148@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6149@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6150
6151@table @code
6152@kindex disable tracepoint
6153@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6154Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6155@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6156the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6157a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6158
6159@kindex enable tracepoint
6160@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6161Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6162tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6163run.
6164@end table
6165
6166@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6167@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6168
6169@table @code
6170@kindex passcount
6171@cindex tracepoint pass count
6172@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6173Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6174automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6175@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6176the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6177@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6178passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6179given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6180user.
6181
6182Examples:
6183
6184@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6185(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6186@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6187
6188(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6189@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6190(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6191(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6192(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6193(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6194(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6195(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6196@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6197@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6198@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6199@end smallexample
6200@end table
6201
6202@node Tracepoint Actions
6203@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6204
6205@table @code
6206@kindex actions
6207@cindex tracepoint actions
6208@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6209This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6210tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6211specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6212recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6213@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6214actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6215terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6216far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6217@code{while-stepping}.
6218
6219@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6220To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6221and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6222
6223@smallexample
6224(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6225
6826cf00 6226(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6227
6826cf00 6228(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6229@end smallexample
6230
6231In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6232commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6233hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6234following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6235followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6236@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6237@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6238@code{end} command.
6239
6240@smallexample
6241(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6242(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6243Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6244> collect bar,baz
6245> collect $regs
6246> while-stepping 12
6247 > collect $fp, $sp
6248 > end
6249end
6250@end smallexample
6251
6252@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6253@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6254Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6255This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6256In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6257special arguments are supported:
6258
6259@table @code
6260@item $regs
6261collect all registers
6262
6263@item $args
6264collect all function arguments
6265
6266@item $locals
6267collect all local variables.
6268@end table
6269
6270You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6271with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6272arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6273
f5c37c66
EZ
6274The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6275particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6276
b37052ae
EZ
6277@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6278@item while-stepping @var{n}
6279Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6280new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6281followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6282its own @code{end} command):
6283
6284@smallexample
6285> while-stepping 12
6286 > collect $regs, myglobal
6287 > end
6288>
6289@end smallexample
6290
6291@noindent
6292You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6293@code{stepping}.
6294@end table
6295
6296@node Listing Tracepoints
6297@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6298
6299@table @code
6300@kindex info tracepoints
6301@cindex information about tracepoints
6302@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6303Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6304a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6305defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6306shown:
6307
6308@itemize @bullet
6309@item
6310its number
6311@item
6312whether it is enabled or disabled
6313@item
6314its address
6315@item
6316its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6317@item
6318its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6319@item
6320where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6321@item
6322its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6323@end itemize
6324
6325@smallexample
6326(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6327Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
63281 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
63292 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
63303 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6331(@value{GDBP})
6332@end smallexample
6333
6334@noindent
6335This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6336@end table
6337
6338@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6339@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6340
6341@table @code
6342@kindex tstart
6343@cindex start a new trace experiment
6344@cindex collected data discarded
6345@item tstart
6346This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6347begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6348the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6349experiment.
6350
6351@kindex tstop
6352@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6353@item tstop
6354This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6355stops collecting data.
6356
6357@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6358automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6359(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6360
6361@kindex tstatus
6362@cindex status of trace data collection
6363@cindex trace experiment, status of
6364@item tstatus
6365This command displays the status of the current trace data
6366collection.
6367@end table
6368
6369Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6370
6371@smallexample
6372(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6373(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6374Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6375> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6376> while-stepping 11
6377 > collect $regs
6378 > end
6379> end
6380(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6381 [time passes @dots{}]
6382(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6383@end smallexample
6384
6385
6386@node Analyze Collected Data
6387@section Using the collected data
6388
6389After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6390for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6391collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6392snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6393consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6394examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6395specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6396snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6397registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6398rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6399debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6400(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6401behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6402when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6403the buffer will fail.
6404
6405@menu
6406* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6407* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6408* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6409@end menu
6410
6411@node tfind
6412@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6413
6414@kindex tfind
6415@cindex select trace snapshot
6416@cindex find trace snapshot
6417The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6418@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6419counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6420snapshot is selected.
6421
6422Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6423
6424@table @code
6425@item tfind start
6426Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6427@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6428
6429@item tfind none
6430Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6431
6432@item tfind end
6433Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6434
6435@item tfind
6436No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6437
6438@item tfind -
6439Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6440retracing earlier steps.
6441
6442@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6443Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6444proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6445argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6446for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6447
6448@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6449Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6450program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6451snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6452snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6453
6454@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6455Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6456addresses.
6457
6458@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6459Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6460@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6461
6462@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6463Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6464the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6465that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6466trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6467next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6468@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6469stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6470@end table
6471
6472The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6473designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6474instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6475snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6476trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6477simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6478snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6479@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6480The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6481for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6482no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6483(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6484no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6485tracepoint as the current one.
6486
6487In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6488these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6489scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6490you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6491registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6492
6493@smallexample
6494(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6495(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6496> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6497 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6498> tfind
6499> end
6500
6501Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6502Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6503Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6504Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6505Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6506Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6507Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6508Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6509Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6510Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6511Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6512@end smallexample
6513
6514Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6515the buffer:
6516
6517@smallexample
6518(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6519(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6520> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6521> tfind line
6522> end
6523
6524Frame 0, X = 1
6525Frame 7, X = 2
6526Frame 13, X = 255
6527@end smallexample
6528
6529@node tdump
6530@subsection @code{tdump}
6531@kindex tdump
6532@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6533@cindex tracepoint data, display
6534
6535This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6536the current trace snapshot.
6537
6538@smallexample
6539(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6540(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6541Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6542> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6543> end
6544
6545(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6546
6547(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6548#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6549at gdb_test.c:444
6550444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6551
6552(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6553Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6554d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6555d1 0x18 24
6556d2 0x80 128
6557d3 0x33 51
6558d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6559d5 0x22 34
6560d6 0xe0 224
6561d7 0x380035 3670069
6562a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6563a1 0x3000668 50333288
6564a2 0x100 256
6565a3 0x322000 3284992
6566a4 0x3000698 50333336
6567a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6568fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6569sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6570ps 0x0 0
6571pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6572fpcontrol 0x0 0
6573fpstatus 0x0 0
6574fpiaddr 0x0 0
6575p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6576p1 = (void *) 0x11
6577p2 = (void *) 0x22
6578p3 = (void *) 0x33
6579p4 = (void *) 0x44
6580p5 = (void *) 0x55
6581p6 = (void *) 0x66
6582gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6583
6584(@value{GDBP})
6585@end smallexample
6586
6587@node save-tracepoints
6588@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6589@kindex save-tracepoints
6590@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6591
6592This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6593their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6594suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6595tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6596Files}).
6597
6598@node Tracepoint Variables
6599@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6600@cindex tracepoint variables
6601@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6602
6603@table @code
6604@vindex $trace_frame
6605@item (int) $trace_frame
6606The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6607snapshot is selected.
6608
6609@vindex $tracepoint
6610@item (int) $tracepoint
6611The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6612
6613@vindex $trace_line
6614@item (int) $trace_line
6615The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6616
6617@vindex $trace_file
6618@item (char []) $trace_file
6619The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6620
6621@vindex $trace_func
6622@item (char []) $trace_func
6623The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6624@end table
6625
6626Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6627use @code{output} instead.
6628
6629Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6630stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6631data.
6632
6633@smallexample
6634(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6635
6636(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6637> output $trace_file
6638> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6639> tfind
6640> end
6641@end smallexample
6642
df0cd8c5
JB
6643@node Overlays
6644@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6645@cindex overlays
6646
6647If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6648memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6649problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6650use overlays.
6651
6652@menu
6653* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6654* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6655* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6656 mapped by asking the inferior.
6657* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6658@end menu
6659
6660@node How Overlays Work
6661@section How Overlays Work
6662@cindex mapped overlays
6663@cindex unmapped overlays
6664@cindex load address, overlay's
6665@cindex mapped address
6666@cindex overlay area
6667
6668Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6669kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6670other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6671management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6672adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6673
6674One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6675independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6676@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6677their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6678instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6679largest overlay as well.
6680
6681Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6682overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6683for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6684there.
6685
c928edc0
AC
6686@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
6687@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
6688@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
6689
474c8240 6690@smallexample
df0cd8c5 6691@group
c928edc0
AC
6692 Data Instruction Larger
6693Address Space Address Space Address Space
6694+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6695| | | | | |
6696+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6697| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
6698| variables | | program | | +-----------+
6699| and heap | | | | | |
6700+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6701| | +-----------+ | | | load address
6702+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
6703 | | | | | |
6704 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
6705 address | | | | | |
6706 | overlay | <-' | | |
6707 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6708 | | <---. | | load address
6709 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
6710 | | | |
6711 +-----------+ | |
6712 +-----------+
6713 | |
6714 +-----------+
6715
6716 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 6717@end group
474c8240 6718@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 6719
c928edc0
AC
6720The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
6721and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
6722its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
6723Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
6724may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
6725data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
6726program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
6727program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
6728
6729An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6730@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6731instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6732in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6733is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6734the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6735called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6736
6737Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6738program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6739global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6740
6741@itemize @bullet
6742
6743@item
6744Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6745must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6746return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6747overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6748
6749@item
6750If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6751will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6752your program's performance.
6753
6754@item
6755The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6756overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6757mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6758and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6759You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6760addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6761ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6762
6763@item
6764The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6765to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6766instruction and data spaces.
6767
6768@end itemize
6769
6770The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6771improved in many ways:
6772
6773@itemize @bullet
6774
6775@item
6776If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6777hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6778contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6779This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6780area in the usual way.
6781
6782@item
6783If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6784overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6785
6786@item
6787You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6788general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6789code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6790return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6791the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6792must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6793different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6794
6795@end itemize
6796
6797
6798@node Overlay Commands
6799@section Overlay Commands
6800
6801To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6802correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6803virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6804mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6805@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6806variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6807
6808@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6809you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6810
6811@table @code
6812@item overlay off
6813@kindex overlay off
6814Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6815disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6816always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6817overlay support is disabled.
6818
6819@item overlay manual
6820@kindex overlay manual
6821@cindex manual overlay debugging
6822Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6823relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6824using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6825commands described below.
6826
6827@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6828@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6829@kindex overlay map-overlay
6830@cindex map an overlay
6831Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6832be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6833overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6834functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6835that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6836@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6837
6838@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6839@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6840@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6841@cindex unmap an overlay
6842Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6843must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6844When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6845overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6846
6847@item overlay auto
6848@kindex overlay auto
6849Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6850consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6851to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6852Overlay Debugging}.
6853
6854@item overlay load-target
6855@itemx overlay load
6856@kindex overlay load-target
6857@cindex reloading the overlay table
6858Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6859re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6860stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6861overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6862useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6863
6864@item overlay list-overlays
6865@itemx overlay list
6866@cindex listing mapped overlays
6867Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6868addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6869
6870@end table
6871
6872Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6873of the function the address falls in:
6874
474c8240 6875@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6876(gdb) print main
6877$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 6878@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6879@noindent
6880When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6881unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6882asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6883unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6884
474c8240 6885@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6886(gdb) overlay list
6887No sections are mapped.
6888(gdb) print foo
6889$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 6890@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6891@noindent
6892When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6893name normally:
6894
474c8240 6895@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6896(gdb) overlay list
6897Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6898 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6899(gdb) print foo
6900$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 6901@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6902
6903When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6904address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6905overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6906@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6907code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6908
6909@itemize @bullet
6910@item
6911@cindex breakpoints in overlays
6912@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
6913You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
6914@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
6915@item
6916@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
6917unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
6918overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
6919you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
6920breakpoints properly.
6921@end itemize
6922
6923
6924@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
6925@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
6926@cindex automatic overlay debugging
6927
6928@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
6929are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
6930inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
6931@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
6932looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
6933current state of the overlays.
6934
6935Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
6936@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
6937
6938@table @asis
6939
6940@item @code{_ovly_table}:
6941This variable must be an array of the following structures:
6942
474c8240 6943@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6944struct
6945@{
6946 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
6947 unsigned long vma;
6948
6949 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
6950 unsigned long size;
6951
6952 /* The overlay's load address. */
6953 unsigned long lma;
6954
6955 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
6956 zero otherwise. */
6957 unsigned long mapped;
6958@}
474c8240 6959@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6960
6961@item @code{_novlys}:
6962This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
6963number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
6964
6965@end table
6966
6967To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
6968looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
6969@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
6970executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
6971the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
6972currently mapped.
6973
81d46470 6974In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 6975@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
6976will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
6977calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
6978will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
6979are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
6980in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
6981overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
6982are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
6983
6984@node Overlay Sample Program
6985@section Overlay Sample Program
6986@cindex overlay example program
6987
6988When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
6989at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
6990addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
6991Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
6992since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
6993architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
6994portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
6995
6996However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
6997program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
6998suite. The program consists of the following files from
6999@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7000
7001@table @file
7002@item overlays.c
7003The main program file.
7004@item ovlymgr.c
7005A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7006@item foo.c
7007@itemx bar.c
7008@itemx baz.c
7009@itemx grbx.c
7010Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7011@item d10v.ld
7012@itemx m32r.ld
7013Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7014and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7015@end table
7016
7017You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7018cross-compiler like this:
7019
474c8240 7020@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7021$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7022$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7023$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7024$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7025$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7026$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7027$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7028 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7029@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7030
7031The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7032you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7033target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7034
7035
6d2ebf8b 7036@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7037@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7038@cindex languages
7039
c906108c
SS
7040Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7041rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7042dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7043Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7044represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7045@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7046
7047@cindex working language
7048Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7049allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7050native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7051consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7052language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7053language}.
7054
7055@menu
7056* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7057* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7058* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7059* Support:: Supported languages
7060@end menu
7061
6d2ebf8b 7062@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7063@section Switching between source languages
7064
7065There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7066set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7067@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7068defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7069used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7070are printed, etc.
7071
7072In addition to the working language, every source file that
7073@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7074file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7075source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7076language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7077controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7078show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7079set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7080set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7081Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7082
7083This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7084as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7085another language. In that case, make the
7086program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7087@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7088program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7089
7090@menu
7091* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7092* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7093* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7094@end menu
7095
6d2ebf8b 7096@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7097@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7098
7099If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7100@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7101
7102@table @file
7103
7104@item .c
7105C source file
7106
7107@item .C
7108@itemx .cc
7109@itemx .cp
7110@itemx .cpp
7111@itemx .cxx
7112@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7113C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7114
7115@item .f
7116@itemx .F
7117Fortran source file
7118
db034ac5
AC
7119@c OBSOLETE @item .ch
7120@c OBSOLETE @itemx .c186
7121@c OBSOLETE @itemx .c286
7122@c OBSOLETE CHILL source file
c906108c 7123
c906108c
SS
7124@item .mod
7125Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7126
7127@item .s
7128@itemx .S
7129Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7130@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7131@end table
7132
7133In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7134extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7135
6d2ebf8b 7136@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7137@subsection Setting the working language
7138
7139If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7140expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7141your program.
7142
7143@kindex set language
7144If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7145command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7146a language, such as
c906108c 7147@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7148For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7149
c906108c
SS
7150Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7151language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7152to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7153source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7154languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7155source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7156command such as:
7157
474c8240 7158@smallexample
c906108c 7159print a = b + c
474c8240 7160@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7161
7162@noindent
7163might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7164@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7165printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7166@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7167
6d2ebf8b 7168@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7169@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7170
7171To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7172@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7173then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7174frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7175working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7176frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7177or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7178does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7179not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7180
7181This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7182entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7183written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7184a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7185case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7186
6d2ebf8b 7187@node Show
c906108c 7188@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7189
7190The following commands help you find out which language is the
7191working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7192
7193@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7194@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7195@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7196@table @code
7197@item show language
7198Display the current working language. This is the
7199language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7200build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7201
7202@item info frame
5d161b24 7203Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7204working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7205@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7206information listed here.
7207
7208@item info source
7209Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7210@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7211information listed here.
7212@end table
7213
7214In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7215not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7216with a language explicitly:
7217
7218@kindex set extension-language
7219@kindex info extensions
7220@table @code
7221@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7222Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7223the source language @var{language}.
7224
7225@item info extensions
7226List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7227@end table
7228
6d2ebf8b 7229@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7230@section Type and range checking
7231
7232@quotation
7233@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7234checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7235section documents the intended facilities.
7236@end quotation
7237@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7238
7239Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7240errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7241checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7242sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7243these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7244by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7245errors when your program is running.
7246
7247@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7248Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7249can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7250the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7251@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7252your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7253for the default settings of supported languages.
7254
7255@menu
7256* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7257* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7258@end menu
7259
7260@cindex type checking
7261@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7262@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7263@subsection An overview of type checking
7264
7265Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7266arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7267otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7268errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7269
7270@smallexample
72711 + 2 @result{} 3
7272@exdent but
7273@error{} 1 + 2.3
7274@end smallexample
7275
7276The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7277type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7278
5d161b24
DB
7279For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7280@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7281to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7282or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7283but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7284these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7285also issues a warning.
7286
5d161b24
DB
7287Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7288related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7289For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7290a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7291with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7292the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7293
7294Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7295instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7296operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7297represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7298operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7299details on specific languages.
7300
7301@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7302
d4f3574e 7303@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7304@kindex set check type
7305@kindex show check type
7306@table @code
7307@item set check type auto
7308Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7309@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7310each language.
7311
7312@item set check type on
7313@itemx set check type off
7314Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7315current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7316match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7317evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7318message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7319
7320@item set check type warn
7321Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7322evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7323be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7324numbers and structures.
7325
7326@item show type
5d161b24 7327Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7328is setting it automatically.
7329@end table
7330
7331@cindex range checking
7332@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7333@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7334@subsection An overview of range checking
7335
7336In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7337bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7338checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7339computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7340not exceed the bounds of the array.
7341
7342For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7343@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7344always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7345warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7346
7347A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7348array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7349of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7350error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7351result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7352the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7353
474c8240 7354@smallexample
c906108c 7355@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7356@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7357
7358This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7359specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7360Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7361
7362@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7363
d4f3574e 7364@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7365@kindex set check range
7366@kindex show check range
7367@table @code
7368@item set check range auto
7369Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7370@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7371each language.
7372
7373@item set check range on
7374@itemx set check range off
7375Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7376current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7377match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7378then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7379
7380@item set check range warn
7381Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7382but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7383expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7384memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7385systems).
7386
7387@item show range
7388Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7389being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7390@end table
c906108c 7391
6d2ebf8b 7392@node Support
c906108c 7393@section Supported languages
c906108c 7394
db034ac5
AC
7395@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java,
7396@c OBSOLETE Chill,
7397assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7398@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7399Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7400language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7401and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7402,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7403language.
7404
7405The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7406supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7407tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7408@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7409formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7410books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7411language reference or tutorial.
7412
c906108c 7413@menu
b37052ae 7414* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7415* Modula-2:: Modula-2
db034ac5 7416@c OBSOLETE * Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
7417@end menu
7418
6d2ebf8b 7419@node C
b37052ae 7420@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7421
b37052ae
EZ
7422@cindex C and C@t{++}
7423@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7424
b37052ae 7425Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7426to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7427together.
7428
41afff9a
EZ
7429@cindex C@t{++}
7430@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7431@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7432The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7433compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7434effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7435C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7436compiler (@code{aCC}).
7437
b37052ae 7438For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7439format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7440command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7441@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7442CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7443
c906108c 7444@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7445* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7446* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7447* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7448* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7449* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7450* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7451* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7452@end menu
c906108c 7453
6d2ebf8b 7454@node C Operators
b37052ae 7455@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7456
b37052ae 7457@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7458
7459Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7460@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7461often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7462
b37052ae 7463For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7464
7465@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7466
c906108c 7467@item
c906108c 7468@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7469specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7470
7471@item
d4f3574e
SS
7472@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7473@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7474
7475@item
53a5351d 7476@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7477
7478@item
7479@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7480
c906108c
SS
7481@end itemize
7482
7483@noindent
7484The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7485in order of increasing precedence:
7486
7487@table @code
7488@item ,
7489The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7490are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7491expression being the last expression evaluated.
7492
7493@item =
7494Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7495assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7496
7497@item @var{op}=
7498Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7499and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7500@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7501@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7502@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7503
7504@item ?:
7505The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7506of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7507integral type.
7508
7509@item ||
7510Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7511
7512@item &&
7513Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7514
7515@item |
7516Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7517
7518@item ^
7519Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7520
7521@item &
7522Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7523
7524@item ==@r{, }!=
7525Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7526expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7527
7528@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7529Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7530Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7531and non-zero for true.
7532
7533@item <<@r{, }>>
7534left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7535
7536@item @@
7537The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7538
7539@item +@r{, }-
7540Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7541pointer types.
7542
7543@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7544Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7545defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7546integral types.
7547
7548@item ++@r{, }--
7549Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7550operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7551when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7552operation takes place.
7553
7554@item *
7555Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7556@code{++}.
7557
7558@item &
7559Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7560
b37052ae
EZ
7561For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7562allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7563(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7564where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7565stored.
c906108c
SS
7566
7567@item -
7568Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7569precedence as @code{++}.
7570
7571@item !
7572Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7573@code{++}.
7574
7575@item ~
7576Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7577@code{++}.
7578
7579
7580@item .@r{, }->
7581Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7582@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7583pointer based on the stored type information.
7584Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7585
c906108c
SS
7586@item .*@r{, }->*
7587Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7588
7589@item []
7590Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7591@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7592
7593@item ()
7594Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7595
c906108c 7596@item ::
b37052ae 7597C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7598and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7599
7600@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7601Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7602(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7603above.
c906108c
SS
7604@end table
7605
c906108c
SS
7606If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7607attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7608predefined meaning.
c906108c 7609
c906108c 7610@menu
5d161b24 7611* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7612@end menu
7613
6d2ebf8b 7614@node C Constants
b37052ae 7615@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7616
b37052ae 7617@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7618
b37052ae 7619@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7620following ways:
c906108c
SS
7621
7622@itemize @bullet
7623@item
7624Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7625specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7626by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7627@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7628@code{long} value.
7629
7630@item
7631Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7632point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7633exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7634@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7635sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7636A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7637@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7638the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7639a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7640constant.
c906108c
SS
7641
7642@item
7643Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7644integral equivalents.
7645
7646@item
7647Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7648(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7649(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7650be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7651the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7652of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7653@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7654@samp{\n} for newline.
7655
7656@item
96a2c332
SS
7657String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7658double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7659above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7660a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7661characters.
c906108c
SS
7662
7663@item
7664Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7665to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7666
7667@item
7668Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7669and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7670integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7671and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7672@end itemize
7673
c906108c 7674@menu
5d161b24
DB
7675* C plus plus expressions::
7676* C Defaults::
7677* C Checks::
c906108c 7678
5d161b24 7679* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
7680@end menu
7681
6d2ebf8b 7682@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
7683@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7684
7685@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7686@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7687
7688@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7689@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7690@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7691@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7692@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7693@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7694@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7695@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7696@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7697@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7698@c periodically whether this has happened...
7699@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
7700@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7701proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
7702additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7703special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7704@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7705symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7706you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7707extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 7708@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7709support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7710@end quotation
c906108c
SS
7711
7712@enumerate
7713
7714@cindex member functions
7715@item
7716Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7717
474c8240 7718@smallexample
c906108c 7719count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 7720@end smallexample
c906108c 7721
41afff9a 7722@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 7723@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7724@item
7725While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7726expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7727that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 7728pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 7729
c906108c 7730@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 7731@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 7732@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7733@item
7734You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 7735call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
7736perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7737calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7738in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7739default arguments.
7740
7741It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7742promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7743class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7744functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7745number of function arguments.
7746
7747Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7748@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 7749,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 7750
d4f3574e 7751You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
7752explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7753@smallexample
7754p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7755@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7756
c906108c 7757The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7758see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7759
c906108c
SS
7760@cindex reference declarations
7761@item
b37052ae
EZ
7762@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7763them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7764dereferenced.
7765
7766In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7767reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7768avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7769The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7770you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7771
7772@item
b37052ae 7773@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7774expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7775one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7776necessary, for example in an expression like
7777@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7778resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7779debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7780@end enumerate
7781
b37052ae 7782In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7783calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7784objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7785invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7786
6d2ebf8b 7787@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7788@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7789
b37052ae 7790@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7791
c906108c
SS
7792If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7793both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7794C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7795selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7796
7797If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7798recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7799@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7800these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7801@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7802for further details.
7803
c906108c
SS
7804@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7805@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7806@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7807
6d2ebf8b 7808@node C Checks
b37052ae 7809@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7810
b37052ae 7811@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7812
b37052ae 7813By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7814is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7815considers two variables type equivalent if:
7816
7817@itemize @bullet
7818@item
7819The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7820enumerated tag.
7821
7822@item
7823The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7824declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7825
7826@ignore
7827@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7828@c FIXME--beers?
7829@item
7830The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7831declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7832compilers.)
7833@end ignore
7834@end itemize
7835
7836Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7837indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7838that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7839
6d2ebf8b 7840@node Debugging C
c906108c 7841@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7842
7843The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7844the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7845inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7846appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7847
7848The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7849with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7850,Expressions}.
7851
c906108c 7852@menu
5d161b24 7853* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7854@end menu
7855
6d2ebf8b 7856@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7857@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7858
b37052ae 7859@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7860
b37052ae
EZ
7861Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7862designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7863
7864@table @code
7865@cindex break in overloaded functions
7866@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7867When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7868@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7869you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7870
b37052ae 7871@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7872@item rbreak @var{regex}
7873Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7874breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7875classes.
7876@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7877
b37052ae 7878@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7879@item catch throw
7880@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7881Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7882Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7883
7884@cindex inheritance
7885@item ptype @var{typename}
7886Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7887@var{typename}.
7888@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7889
b37052ae 7890@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7891@item set print demangle
7892@itemx show print demangle
7893@itemx set print asm-demangle
7894@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7895Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7896displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7897@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7898
7899@item set print object
7900@itemx show print object
7901Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7902@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7903
7904@item set print vtbl
7905@itemx show print vtbl
7906Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7907@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7908(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7909ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7910
7911@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7912@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7913@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7914Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7915is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7916and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7917using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7918expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7919message.
7920
7921@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7922Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7923overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7924chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7925symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7926overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7927searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7928argument types.
c906108c
SS
7929
7930@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7931You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7932the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7933@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7934also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7935available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7936@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7937@end table
c906108c 7938
6d2ebf8b 7939@node Modula-2
c906108c 7940@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7941
d4f3574e 7942@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7943
7944The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7945output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7946developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7947attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7948to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7949table.
7950
7951@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7952@menu
7953* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7954* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7955* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7956* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7957* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7958* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7959* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7960* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7961@end menu
7962
6d2ebf8b 7963@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7964@subsubsection Operators
7965@cindex Modula-2 operators
7966
7967Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7968@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7969often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7970following definitions hold:
7971
7972@itemize @bullet
7973
7974@item
7975@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7976their subranges.
7977
7978@item
7979@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7980
7981@item
7982@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7983
7984@item
7985@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7986@var{type}}.
7987
7988@item
7989@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7990
7991@item
7992@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7993
7994@item
7995@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7996@end itemize
7997
7998@noindent
7999The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8000increasing precedence:
8001
8002@table @code
8003@item ,
8004Function argument or array index separator.
8005
8006@item :=
8007Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8008@var{value}.
8009
8010@item <@r{, }>
8011Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8012types.
8013
8014@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8015Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8016on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8017set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8018
8019@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8020Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8021Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8022available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8023comment character.
8024
8025@item IN
8026Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8027Same precedence as @code{<}.
8028
8029@item OR
8030Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8031
8032@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8033Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8034
8035@item @@
8036The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8037
8038@item +@r{, }-
8039Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8040and difference on set types.
8041
8042@item *
8043Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8044on set types.
8045
8046@item /
8047Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8048types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8049
8050@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8051Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8052precedence as @code{*}.
8053
8054@item -
8055Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8056
8057@item ^
8058Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8059
8060@item NOT
8061Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8062@code{^}.
8063
8064@item .
8065@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8066precedence as @code{^}.
8067
8068@item []
8069Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8070
8071@item ()
8072Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8073as @code{^}.
8074
8075@item ::@r{, }.
8076@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8077@end table
8078
8079@quotation
8080@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8081treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8082@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8083@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8084@end quotation
8085
cb51c4e0 8086
6d2ebf8b 8087@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8088@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8089@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8090
8091Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8092In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8093
8094@table @var
8095
8096@item a
8097represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8098
8099@item c
8100represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8101
8102@item i
8103represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8104
8105@item m
8106represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8107same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8108be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8109
8110@item n
8111represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8112
8113@item r
8114represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8115
8116@item t
8117represents a type.
8118
8119@item v
8120represents a variable.
8121
8122@item x
8123represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8124explanation of the function for details.
8125@end table
8126
8127All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8128
8129@table @code
8130@item ABS(@var{n})
8131Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8132
8133@item CAP(@var{c})
8134If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8135equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8136
8137@item CHR(@var{i})
8138Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8139
8140@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8141Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8142
8143@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8144Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8145new value.
8146
8147@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8148Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8149set.
8150
8151@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8152Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8153
8154@item HIGH(@var{a})
8155Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8156
8157@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8158Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8159
8160@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8161Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8162new value.
8163
8164@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8165Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8166there. Returns the new set.
8167
8168@item MAX(@var{t})
8169Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8170
8171@item MIN(@var{t})
8172Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8173
8174@item ODD(@var{i})
8175Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8176
8177@item ORD(@var{x})
8178Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8179value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8180@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8181integral, character and enumerated types.
8182
8183@item SIZE(@var{x})
8184Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8185
8186@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8187Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8188
8189@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8190Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8191@end table
8192
8193@quotation
8194@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8195@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8196an error.
8197@end quotation
8198
8199@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8200@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8201@subsubsection Constants
8202
8203@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8204ways:
8205
8206@itemize @bullet
8207
8208@item
8209Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8210expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8211rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8212trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8213
8214@item
8215Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8216decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8217then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8218@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8219digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8220digits.
8221
8222@item
8223Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8224like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8225also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8226followed by a @samp{C}.
8227
8228@item
8229String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8230pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8231Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8232Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8233sequences.
8234
8235@item
8236Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8237
8238@item
8239Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8240@code{FALSE}.
8241
8242@item
8243Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8244
8245@item
8246Set constants are not yet supported.
8247@end itemize
8248
6d2ebf8b 8249@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8250@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8251@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8252
8253If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8254both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8255Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8256selected the working language.
8257
8258If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8259code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8260working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8261the language automatically}, for further details.
8262
6d2ebf8b 8263@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8264@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8265@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8266
8267A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8268This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8269
8270@itemize @bullet
8271@item
8272Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8273integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8274debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8275pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8276through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8277returned a pointer.)
8278
8279@item
8280C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8281non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8282escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8283printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8284
8285@item
8286The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8287argument.
8288
8289@item
8290All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8291@end itemize
8292
6d2ebf8b 8293@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8294@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8295@cindex Modula-2 checks
8296
8297@quotation
8298@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8299range checking.
8300@end quotation
8301@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8302
8303@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8304
8305@itemize @bullet
8306@item
8307They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8308@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8309
8310@item
8311They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8312@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8313@end itemize
8314
8315As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8316whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8317
8318Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8319index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8320
6d2ebf8b 8321@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8322@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8323@cindex scope
41afff9a 8324@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8325@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8326@ifinfo
41afff9a 8327@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8328@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8329@end ifinfo
8330@iftex
41afff9a 8331@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8332@end iftex
8333
8334There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8335(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8336similar syntax:
8337
474c8240 8338@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8339
8340@var{module} . @var{id}
8341@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8342@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8343
8344@noindent
8345where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8346@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8347identifier within your program, except another module.
8348
8349Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8350specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8351found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8352enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8353
8354Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8355the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8356definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8357an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8358module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8359@var{module}.
8360
6d2ebf8b 8361@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8362@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8363
8364Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8365Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8366specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8367@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8368apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8369analogue in Modula-2.
8370
8371The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8372with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8373intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8374created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8375address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8376@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8377
8378@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8379In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8380interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8381
db034ac5
AC
8382@c OBSOLETE @node Chill
8383@c OBSOLETE @subsection Chill
8384@c OBSOLETE
8385@c OBSOLETE The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
8386@c OBSOLETE from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
8387@c OBSOLETE supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8388@c OBSOLETE likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8389@c OBSOLETE table.
8390@c OBSOLETE
8391@c OBSOLETE @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8392@c OBSOLETE @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8393@c OBSOLETE This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
8394@c OBSOLETE of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8395@c OBSOLETE
8396@c OBSOLETE @menu
8397@c OBSOLETE * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8398@c OBSOLETE * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
8399@c OBSOLETE * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
8400@c OBSOLETE * Chill type and range checks::
8401@c OBSOLETE * Chill defaults::
8402@c OBSOLETE @end menu
8403@c OBSOLETE
8404@c OBSOLETE @node How modes are displayed
8405@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection How modes are displayed
8406@c OBSOLETE
8407@c OBSOLETE The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
8408@c OBSOLETE with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
8409@c OBSOLETE slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8410@c OBSOLETE provided modes are:
8411@c OBSOLETE
8412@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8413@c OBSOLETE @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
8414@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8415@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8416@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8417@c OBSOLETE @item
8418@c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8419@c OBSOLETE UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8420@c OBSOLETE @item
8421@c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
8422@c OBSOLETE @item
8423@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
8424@c OBSOLETE @item
8425@c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8426@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8427@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8428@c OBSOLETE type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8429@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8430@c OBSOLETE If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8431@c OBSOLETE @item
8432@c OBSOLETE @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8433@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8434@c OBSOLETE @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8435@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8436@c OBSOLETE where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8437@c OBSOLETE expression (e.g. set element names).
8438@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8439@c OBSOLETE
8440@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8441@c OBSOLETE A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
8442@c OBSOLETE the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
8443@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8444@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8445@c OBSOLETE type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8446@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8447@c OBSOLETE
8448@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8449@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8450@c OBSOLETE @item
8451@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
8452@c OBSOLETE followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8453@c OBSOLETE @item
8454@c OBSOLETE @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8455@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8456@c OBSOLETE
8457@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8458@c OBSOLETE The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8459@c OBSOLETE <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
8460@c OBSOLETE list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8461@c OBSOLETE the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
8462@c OBSOLETE all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8463@c OBSOLETE
8464@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8465@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8466@c OBSOLETE The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
8467@c OBSOLETE type, and is therefore not really of interest.
8468@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8469@c OBSOLETE
8470@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
8471@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8472@c OBSOLETE @item
8473@c OBSOLETE @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8474@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8475@c OBSOLETE @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8476@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8477@c OBSOLETE where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8478@c OBSOLETE @item
8479@c OBSOLETE @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8480@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8481@c OBSOLETE @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8482@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8483@c OBSOLETE where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
8484@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8485@c OBSOLETE
8486@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
8487@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8488@c OBSOLETE @item
8489@c OBSOLETE @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8490@c OBSOLETE @item
8491@c OBSOLETE @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8492@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8493@c OBSOLETE
8494@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8495@c OBSOLETE Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8496@c OBSOLETE
8497@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8498@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8499@c OBSOLETE @item
8500@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8501@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8502@c OBSOLETE @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8503@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8504@c OBSOLETE followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8505@c OBSOLETE mode
8506@c OBSOLETE @item
8507@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8508@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8509@c OBSOLETE @code{BOOLS(<string
8510@c OBSOLETE length>)}
8511@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8512@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8513@c OBSOLETE
8514@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8515@c OBSOLETE The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8516@c OBSOLETE followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8517@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8518@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8519@c OBSOLETE type = ARRAY (1:42)
8520@c OBSOLETE ARRAY (1:20)
8521@c OBSOLETE SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8522@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8523@c OBSOLETE
8524@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
8525@c OBSOLETE The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
8526@c OBSOLETE list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8527@c OBSOLETE of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8528@c OBSOLETE OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
8529@c OBSOLETE of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8530@c OBSOLETE checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8531@c OBSOLETE always displays all variant fields.
8532@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8533@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8534@c OBSOLETE type = STRUCT (
8535@c OBSOLETE as x,
8536@c OBSOLETE bs x,
8537@c OBSOLETE CASE bs OF
8538@c OBSOLETE (karli):
8539@c OBSOLETE cs a
8540@c OBSOLETE (ott):
8541@c OBSOLETE ds x
8542@c OBSOLETE ESAC
8543@c OBSOLETE )
8544@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8545@c OBSOLETE @end table
8546@c OBSOLETE
8547@c OBSOLETE @node Locations
8548@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8549@c OBSOLETE
8550@c OBSOLETE A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8551@c OBSOLETE
8552@c OBSOLETE A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
8553@c OBSOLETE the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8554@c OBSOLETE Chill programs. How values are specified
8555@c OBSOLETE is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
8556@c OBSOLETE
8557@c OBSOLETE The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8558@c OBSOLETE display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
8559@c OBSOLETE
8560@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8561@c OBSOLETE set result := EXPR
8562@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8563@c OBSOLETE
8564@c OBSOLETE @noindent
8565@c OBSOLETE This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
8566@c OBSOLETE is not available in @value{GDBN}).
8567@c OBSOLETE
8568@c OBSOLETE Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8569@c OBSOLETE value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
8570@c OBSOLETE mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
8571@c OBSOLETE represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8572@c OBSOLETE value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
8573@c OBSOLETE operator @samp{->}.
8574@c OBSOLETE
8575@c OBSOLETE Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8576@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8577@c OBSOLETE @code{@{ PROC
8578@c OBSOLETE (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
8579@c OBSOLETE location>}
8580@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8581@c OBSOLETE @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8582@c OBSOLETE specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8583@c OBSOLETE the entry point.
8584@c OBSOLETE
8585@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8586@c OBSOLETE Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8587@c OBSOLETE fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8588@c OBSOLETE the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
8589@c OBSOLETE implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8590@c OBSOLETE na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8591@c OBSOLETE <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
8592@c OBSOLETE @code{__proc_copy}.
8593@c OBSOLETE
8594@c OBSOLETE Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8595@c OBSOLETE the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8596@c OBSOLETE like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8597@c OBSOLETE mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8598@c OBSOLETE
8599@c OBSOLETE Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
8600@c OBSOLETE ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
8601@c OBSOLETE definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
8602@c OBSOLETE of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8603@c OBSOLETE structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8604@c OBSOLETE braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
8605@c OBSOLETE on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
8606@c OBSOLETE memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
8607@c OBSOLETE all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
8608@c OBSOLETE @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
8609@c OBSOLETE stuff ???)
8610@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8611@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8612@c OBSOLETE [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8613@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8614@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8615@c OBSOLETE
8616@c OBSOLETE Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8617@c OBSOLETE (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
8618@c OBSOLETE certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8619@c OBSOLETE and their Operations}.
8620@c OBSOLETE
8621@c OBSOLETE A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
8622@c OBSOLETE location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8623@c OBSOLETE name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8624@c OBSOLETE have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8625@c OBSOLETE checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
8626@c OBSOLETE therefore the result can be quite confusing.
8627@c OBSOLETE
8628@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8629@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8630@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8631@c OBSOLETE
8632@c OBSOLETE @node Values and their Operations
8633@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Values and their Operations
8634@c OBSOLETE
8635@c OBSOLETE Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8636@c OBSOLETE more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
8637@c OBSOLETE data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8638@c OBSOLETE such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
8639@c OBSOLETE constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
8640@c OBSOLETE when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
8641@c OBSOLETE (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8642@c OBSOLETE the values behind these locations.
8643@c OBSOLETE
8644@c OBSOLETE This section describes how values have to be specified and which
8645@c OBSOLETE operations are legal to be used with such values.
8646@c OBSOLETE
8647@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8648@c OBSOLETE @item Literal Values
8649@c OBSOLETE Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8650@c OBSOLETE For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
8651@c OBSOLETE chapter 1.5.
8652@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8653@c OBSOLETE @c be converted to a @ref.
8654@c OBSOLETE
8655@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8656@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8657@c OBSOLETE @item
8658@c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8659@c OBSOLETE programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
8660@c OBSOLETE @item
8661@c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8662@c OBSOLETE @item
8663@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8664@c OBSOLETE @code{'M'})
8665@c OBSOLETE @item
8666@c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
8667@c OBSOLETE mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
8668@c OBSOLETE comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
8669@c OBSOLETE @item
8670@c OBSOLETE @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
8671@c OBSOLETE emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
8672@c OBSOLETE procedure value or the empty instance value.
8673@c OBSOLETE
8674@c OBSOLETE @item
8675@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
8676@c OBSOLETE enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
8677@c OBSOLETE to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8678@c OBSOLETE @item
8679@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8680@c OBSOLETE programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8681@c OBSOLETE @item
8682@c OBSOLETE @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
8683@c OBSOLETE (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
8684@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8685@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8686@c OBSOLETE
8687@c OBSOLETE @item Tuple Values
8688@c OBSOLETE A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
8689@c OBSOLETE name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
8690@c OBSOLETE unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8691@c OBSOLETE @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
8692@c OBSOLETE
8693@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8694@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8695@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Array Tuple}
8696@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8697@c OBSOLETE Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
8698@c OBSOLETE same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
8699@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8700@c OBSOLETE
8701@c OBSOLETE @item String Element Value
8702@c OBSOLETE A string element value is specified by
8703@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8704@c OBSOLETE @code{<string value>(<index>)}
8705@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8706@c OBSOLETE where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
8707@c OBSOLETE value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8708@c OBSOLETE the string.
8709@c OBSOLETE
8710@c OBSOLETE @item String Slice Value
8711@c OBSOLETE A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8712@c OBSOLETE spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8713@c OBSOLETE expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8714@c OBSOLETE @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8715@c OBSOLETE The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8716@c OBSOLETE string.
8717@c OBSOLETE
8718@c OBSOLETE @item Array Element Values
8719@c OBSOLETE An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8720@c OBSOLETE delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8721@c OBSOLETE
8722@c OBSOLETE @item Array Slice Values
8723@c OBSOLETE An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8724@c OBSOLETE @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
8725@c OBSOLETE @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8726@c OBSOLETE arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
8727@c OBSOLETE which is part of the specified array.
8728@c OBSOLETE
8729@c OBSOLETE @item Structure Field Values
8730@c OBSOLETE A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
8731@c OBSOLETE name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8732@c OBSOLETE in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
8733@c OBSOLETE corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8734@c OBSOLETE
8735@c OBSOLETE @item Procedure Call Value
8736@c OBSOLETE The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8737@c OBSOLETE procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8738@c OBSOLETE expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
8739@c OBSOLETE effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
8740@c OBSOLETE
8741@c OBSOLETE Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
8742@c OBSOLETE
8743@c OBSOLETE Values of time mode locations appear as
8744@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8745@c OBSOLETE @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8746@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8747@c OBSOLETE
8748@c OBSOLETE
8749@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8750@c OBSOLETE This is not implemented yet:
8751@c OBSOLETE @item Built-in Value
8752@c OBSOLETE @noindent
8753@c OBSOLETE The following built in functions are provided:
8754@c OBSOLETE
8755@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8756@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ADDR()}
8757@c OBSOLETE @item @code{NUM()}
8758@c OBSOLETE @item @code{PRED()}
8759@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SUCC()}
8760@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ABS()}
8761@c OBSOLETE @item @code{CARD()}
8762@c OBSOLETE @item @code{MAX()}
8763@c OBSOLETE @item @code{MIN()}
8764@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIZE()}
8765@c OBSOLETE @item @code{UPPER()}
8766@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOWER()}
8767@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LENGTH()}
8768@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIN()}
8769@c OBSOLETE @item @code{COS()}
8770@c OBSOLETE @item @code{TAN()}
8771@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCSIN()}
8772@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCCOS()}
8773@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCTAN()}
8774@c OBSOLETE @item @code{EXP()}
8775@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LN()}
8776@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOG()}
8777@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SQRT()}
8778@c OBSOLETE @end table
8779@c OBSOLETE
8780@c OBSOLETE For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8781@c OBSOLETE chapter 1.6.
8782@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8783@c OBSOLETE
8784@c OBSOLETE @item Zero-adic Operator Value
8785@c OBSOLETE The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8786@c OBSOLETE current active process.
8787@c OBSOLETE
8788@c OBSOLETE @item Expression Values
8789@c OBSOLETE The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
8790@c OBSOLETE the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
8791@c OBSOLETE incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
8792@c OBSOLETE corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
8793@c OBSOLETE causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
8794@c OBSOLETE which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
8795@c OBSOLETE operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
8796@c OBSOLETE
8797@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8798@c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
8799@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8800@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
8801@c OBSOLETE Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
8802@c OBSOLETE
8803@c OBSOLETE @item @code{=, /=}
8804@c OBSOLETE Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
8805@c OBSOLETE
8806@c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
8807@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
8808@c OBSOLETE Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
8809@c OBSOLETE
8810@c OBSOLETE @item @code{+, -}
8811@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
8812@c OBSOLETE Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
8813@c OBSOLETE
8814@c OBSOLETE @item @code{-}
8815@c OBSOLETE Change sign operator.
8816@c OBSOLETE
8817@c OBSOLETE @item @code{//}
8818@c OBSOLETE String concatenation operator.
8819@c OBSOLETE
8820@c OBSOLETE @item @code{()}
8821@c OBSOLETE String repetition operator.
8822@c OBSOLETE
8823@c OBSOLETE @item @code{->}
8824@c OBSOLETE Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8825@c OBSOLETE address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8826@c OBSOLETE location (@code{loc->}).
8827@c OBSOLETE
8828@c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, XOR}
8829@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND}
8830@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
8831@c OBSOLETE Powerset and bitstring operators.
8832@c OBSOLETE
8833@c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
8834@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
8835@c OBSOLETE Powerset inclusion operators.
8836@c OBSOLETE
8837@c OBSOLETE @item @code{IN}
8838@c OBSOLETE Membership operator.
8839@c OBSOLETE @end table
8840@c OBSOLETE @end table
8841@c OBSOLETE
8842@c OBSOLETE @node Chill type and range checks
8843@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8844@c OBSOLETE
8845@c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
8846@c OBSOLETE of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
8847@c OBSOLETE complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
8848@c OBSOLETE equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
8849@c OBSOLETE structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8850@c OBSOLETE
8851@c OBSOLETE Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8852@c OBSOLETE index bounds and all built in procedures.
8853@c OBSOLETE
8854@c OBSOLETE Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
8855@c OBSOLETE check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
8856@c OBSOLETE operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8857@c OBSOLETE functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8858@c OBSOLETE language specification.
8859@c OBSOLETE
8860@c OBSOLETE All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8861@c OBSOLETE off}.
8862@c OBSOLETE
8863@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8864@c OBSOLETE @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
8865@c OBSOLETE see last paragraph ?
8866@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8867@c OBSOLETE
8868@c OBSOLETE @node Chill defaults
8869@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill defaults
8870@c OBSOLETE
8871@c OBSOLETE If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8872@c OBSOLETE both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8873@c OBSOLETE Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8874@c OBSOLETE selected the working language.
8875@c OBSOLETE
8876@c OBSOLETE If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8877@c OBSOLETE code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
8878@c OBSOLETE working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8879@c OBSOLETE the language automatically}, for further details.
cce74817 8880
6d2ebf8b 8881@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8882@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8883
d4f3574e 8884The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8885symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8886program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8887does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8888program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8889(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8890file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8891
8892@cindex symbol names
8893@cindex names of symbols
8894@cindex quoting names
8895Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8896characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8897most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8898source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8899are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8900ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8901@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8902@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8903
474c8240 8904@smallexample
c906108c 8905p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8906@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8907
8908@noindent
8909looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8910
8911@table @code
8912@kindex info address
b37052ae 8913@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8914@item info address @var{symbol}
8915Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8916variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8917local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8918is always stored.
8919
8920Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8921at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8922the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8923
3d67e040 8924@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8925@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8926@item info symbol @var{addr}
8927Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8928If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8929nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8930
474c8240 8931@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8932(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8933_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8934@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8935
8936@noindent
8937This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8938it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8939
c906108c 8940@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8941@item whatis @var{expr}
8942Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8943actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8944assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8945@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8946
8947@item whatis
8948Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8949
8950@kindex ptype
8951@item ptype @var{typename}
8952Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8953the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8954@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8955@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8956
d4f3574e 8957@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8958@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8959Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8960differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8961of just the name of the type.
8962
8963For example, for this variable declaration:
8964
474c8240 8965@smallexample
c906108c 8966struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8967@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8968
8969@noindent
8970the two commands give this output:
8971
474c8240 8972@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8973@group
8974(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8975type = struct complex
8976(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8977type = struct complex @{
8978 double real;
8979 double imag;
8980@}
8981@end group
474c8240 8982@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8983
8984@noindent
8985As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8986the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8987
8988@kindex info types
8989@item info types @var{regexp}
8990@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8991Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8992(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8993complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8994@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8995names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8996information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8997
8998This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8999@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9000lists all source files where a type is defined.
9001
b37052ae
EZ
9002@kindex info scope
9003@cindex local variables
9004@item info scope @var{addr}
9005List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9006accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9007preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9008scope defined by that location. For example:
9009
9010@smallexample
9011(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9012Scope for command_line_handler:
9013Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9014Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9015Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9016Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9017Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9018Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9019Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9020@end smallexample
9021
f5c37c66
EZ
9022@noindent
9023This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9024during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9025collect}.
9026
c906108c
SS
9027@kindex info source
9028@item info source
919d772c
JB
9029Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9030the function containing the current point of execution:
9031@itemize @bullet
9032@item
9033the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9034@item
9035the directory it was compiled in,
9036@item
9037its length, in lines,
9038@item
9039which programming language it is written in,
9040@item
9041whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9042if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9043@item
9044whether the debugging information includes information about
9045preprocessor macros.
9046@end itemize
9047
c906108c
SS
9048
9049@kindex info sources
9050@item info sources
9051Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9052debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9053have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9054
9055@kindex info functions
9056@item info functions
9057Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9058
9059@item info functions @var{regexp}
9060Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9061whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9062Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9063include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
9064start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9065that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9066@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
9067
9068@kindex info variables
9069@item info variables
9070Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 9071outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
9072
9073@item info variables @var{regexp}
9074Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9075variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9076@var{regexp}.
9077
9078@ignore
9079This was never implemented.
9080@kindex info methods
9081@item info methods
9082@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9083The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
9084methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9085specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9086C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
9087from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9088@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9089which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9090@end ignore
9091
c906108c
SS
9092@cindex reloading symbols
9093Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
9094be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9095in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9096running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9097@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
9098
9099@table @code
9100@kindex set symbol-reloading
9101@item set symbol-reloading on
9102Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9103object file with a particular name is seen again.
9104
9105@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
9106Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9107same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9108running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9109should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9110may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9111several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9112name.
c906108c
SS
9113
9114@kindex show symbol-reloading
9115@item show symbol-reloading
9116Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9117@end table
c906108c 9118
c906108c
SS
9119@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9120@item set opaque-type-resolution on
9121Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9122declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9123@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9124source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9125another source file. The default is on.
9126
9127A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9128the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9129
9130@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9131Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9132is printed as follows:
9133@smallexample
9134@{<no data fields>@}
9135@end smallexample
9136
9137@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9138@item show opaque-type-resolution
9139Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9140
9141@kindex maint print symbols
9142@cindex symbol dump
9143@kindex maint print psymbols
9144@cindex partial symbol dump
9145@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9146@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9147@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9148Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9149These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9150symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9151symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9152collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9153only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9154command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9155use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9156symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9157files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9158@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9159required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9160@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9161@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9162@end table
9163
6d2ebf8b 9164@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9165@chapter Altering Execution
9166
9167Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9168find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9169correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9170experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9171program.
9172
9173For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9174locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9175address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9176
9177@menu
9178* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9179* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9180* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9181* Returning:: Returning from a function
9182* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9183* Patching:: Patching your program
9184@end menu
9185
6d2ebf8b 9186@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9187@section Assignment to variables
9188
9189@cindex assignment
9190@cindex setting variables
9191To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9192@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9193
474c8240 9194@smallexample
c906108c 9195print x=4
474c8240 9196@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9197
9198@noindent
9199stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9200value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9201@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9202information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9203
9204@kindex set variable
9205@cindex variables, setting
9206If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9207@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9208really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9209not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9210,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9211
c906108c
SS
9212If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9213appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9214variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9215to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9216program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9217a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9218command @code{set width}:
9219
474c8240 9220@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9221(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9222type = double
9223(@value{GDBP}) p width
9224$4 = 13
9225(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9226Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9227@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9228
9229@noindent
9230The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9231order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9232
474c8240 9233@smallexample
c906108c 9234(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9235@end smallexample
53a5351d 9236
c906108c
SS
9237Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9238with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9239@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9240your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9241to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9242the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9243
474c8240 9244@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9245@group
9246(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9247type = double
9248(@value{GDBP}) p g
9249$1 = 1
9250(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9251(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9252$2 = 1
9253(@value{GDBP}) r
9254The program being debugged has been started already.
9255Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9256Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9257"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9258 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9259(@value{GDBP}) show g
9260The current BFD target is "=4".
9261@end group
474c8240 9262@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9263
9264@noindent
9265The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9266@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9267@code{g}, use
9268
474c8240 9269@smallexample
c906108c 9270(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9271@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9272
9273@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9274freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9275and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9276same length or shorter.
9277@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9278@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9279
9280To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9281construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9282(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9283to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9284and representation in memory), and
9285
474c8240 9286@smallexample
c906108c 9287set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9288@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9289
9290@noindent
9291stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9292
6d2ebf8b 9293@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9294@section Continuing at a different address
9295
9296Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9297it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9298an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9299
9300@table @code
9301@kindex jump
9302@item jump @var{linespec}
9303Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9304immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9305source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9306@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9307in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9308breakpoints}.
9309
9310The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9311the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9312register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9313a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9314be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9315of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9316confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9317executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9318well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9319
9320@item jump *@var{address}
9321Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9322@end table
9323
c906108c 9324@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9325On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9326command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9327difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9328changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9329example,
c906108c 9330
474c8240 9331@smallexample
c906108c 9332set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9334
9335@noindent
9336makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9337address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9338@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9339
9340The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9341up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9342that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9343detail.
9344
c906108c 9345@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9346@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9347@section Giving your program a signal
9348
9349@table @code
9350@kindex signal
9351@item signal @var{signal}
9352Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9353signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9354signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9355SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9356
9357Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9358giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9359a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9360@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9361signal.
9362
9363@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9364after executing the command.
9365@end table
9366@c @end group
9367
9368Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9369@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9370causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9371the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9372passes the signal directly to your program.
9373
c906108c 9374
6d2ebf8b 9375@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9376@section Returning from a function
9377
9378@table @code
9379@cindex returning from a function
9380@kindex return
9381@item return
9382@itemx return @var{expression}
9383You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9384command. If you give an
9385@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9386value.
9387@end table
9388
9389When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9390(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9391discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9392be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9393
9394This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9395frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9396innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9397specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9398of functions.
9399
9400The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9401program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9402returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9403and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9404selected stack frame returns naturally.
9405
6d2ebf8b 9406@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9407@section Calling program functions
9408
9409@cindex calling functions
9410@kindex call
9411@table @code
9412@item call @var{expr}
9413Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9414returned values.
9415@end table
9416
9417You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9418execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9419with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9420is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9421
6d2ebf8b 9422@node Patching
c906108c 9423@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9424
c906108c
SS
9425@cindex patching binaries
9426@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9427@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9428
7a292a7a
SS
9429By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9430executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9431alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9432patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9433
9434If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9435explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9436want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9437repairs.
9438
9439@table @code
9440@kindex set write
9441@item set write on
9442@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9443If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9444core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9445off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9446
9447If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9448@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9449write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9450
9451@item show write
9452@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9453Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9454as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9455@end table
9456
6d2ebf8b 9457@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9458@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9459
7a292a7a
SS
9460@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9461both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9462program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9463@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9464
9465@menu
9466* Files:: Commands to specify files
9467* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9468@end menu
9469
6d2ebf8b 9470@node Files
c906108c 9471@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9472
7a292a7a 9473@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9474@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9475
9476You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9477way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9478@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9479Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9480
9481Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9482@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9483a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9484to specify new files are useful.
9485
9486@table @code
9487@cindex executable file
9488@kindex file
9489@item file @var{filename}
9490Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9491symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9492executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9493directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9494@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9495directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9496to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9497and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9498
6d2ebf8b 9499On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9500@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9501@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9502@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9503descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9504(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9505@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9506for more information.
c906108c
SS
9507
9508@item file
9509@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9510has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9511
9512@kindex exec-file
9513@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9514Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9515in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9516if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9517discard information on the executable file.
9518
9519@kindex symbol-file
9520@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9521Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9522searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9523table and program to run from the same file.
9524
9525@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9526program's symbol table.
9527
5d161b24 9528The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9529of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9530auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9531the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9532the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9533
9534@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9535executing it once.
9536
9537When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9538understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9539generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9540other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9541Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9542using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9543optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9544
9545For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9546using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9547symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9548quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9549details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9550
9551The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9552start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9553occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9554file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9555pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9556warnings and messages}.)
9557
c906108c
SS
9558We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9559symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9560symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9561still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9562in stabs format.
9563
9564@kindex readnow
9565@cindex reading symbols immediately
9566@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9567@kindex mapped
9568@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9569@cindex saving symbol table
9570@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9571@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9572You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9573tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9574load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9575entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9576
c906108c
SS
9577If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9578@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9579cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9580file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9581from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9582than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9583program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9584starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9585
9586You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9587file has all the symbol information for your program.
9588
9589The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9590@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9591than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9592it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9593needed.
9594
9595The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9596@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9597symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9598
9599@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9600@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9601@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9602@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9603@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9604@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9605@c files.
9606
9607@kindex core
9608@kindex core-file
9609@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9610Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9611of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9612address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9613executable file itself for other parts.
9614
9615@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9616to be used.
9617
9618Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9619under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9620wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9621the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9622(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9623
c906108c
SS
9624@kindex add-symbol-file
9625@cindex dynamic linking
9626@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9627@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9628@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9629The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9630information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9631when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9632into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9633address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9634this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9635of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9636section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9637@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9638
9639The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9640originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9641@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9642thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9643instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9644
17d9d558
JB
9645@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9646@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9647@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9648@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9649@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9650Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9651executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9652relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9653information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9654
9655@itemize @bullet
9656@item
9657the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9658that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9659@item
9660every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9661been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9662@item
9663you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9664provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9665@end itemize
9666
9667@noindent
9668Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9669relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9670typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9671important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9672procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9673assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9674general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9675relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9676as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9677way.
9678
c906108c
SS
9679@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9680
9681You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9682the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9683table information for @var{filename}.
9684
9685@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9686@item add-shared-symbol-file
9687The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9688operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9689shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9690@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9691
c906108c
SS
9692@kindex section
9693@item section
5d161b24
DB
9694The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9695the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9696section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9697specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9698separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9699the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9700
9701@kindex info files
9702@kindex info target
9703@item info files
9704@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9705@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9706current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9707including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9708use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9709command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9710current ones.
9711
fe95c787
MS
9712@kindex maint info sections
9713@item maint info sections
9714Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9715is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9716displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9717offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9718@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9719may be arbitrarily combined):
9720
9721@table @code
9722@item ALLOBJ
9723Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9724@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9725Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9726@item @var{section-flags}
9727Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9728The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9729@table @code
9730@item ALLOC
9731Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9732Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9733@item LOAD
9734Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9735Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9736@item RELOC
9737Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9738@item READONLY
9739Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9740@item CODE
9741Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9742@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9743Section contains data only (no executable code).
9744@item ROM
9745Section will reside in ROM.
9746@item CONSTRUCTOR
9747Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9748@item HAS_CONTENTS
9749Section is not empty.
9750@item NEVER_LOAD
9751An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9752@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9753A notification to the linker that the section contains
9754COFF shared library information.
9755@item IS_COMMON
9756Section contains common symbols.
9757@end table
9758@end table
6763aef9
MS
9759@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9760@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9761Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9762really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9763In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9764out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9765For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9766enhancement to debugging performance.
9767
9768The default is off.
9769
9770@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9771Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9772the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9773and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9774@end table
9775
9776All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9777as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9778name and remembers it that way.
9779
c906108c 9780@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9781@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9782libraries.
53a5351d 9783
c906108c
SS
9784@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9785when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9786(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9787references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9788debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9789
9790On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9791automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9792
c906108c
SS
9793@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9794@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9795@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9796
b7209cb4
FF
9797There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9798symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9799particularly large or there are many of them.
9800
9801To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9802commands:
9803
9804@table @code
9805@kindex set auto-solib-add
9806@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9807If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9808will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9809attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9810informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9811is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9812@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9813
9814@kindex show auto-solib-add
9815@item show auto-solib-add
9816Display the current autoloading mode.
9817@end table
9818
9819To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9820command:
9821
c906108c
SS
9822@table @code
9823@kindex info sharedlibrary
9824@kindex info share
9825@item info share
9826@itemx info sharedlibrary
9827Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9828
9829@kindex sharedlibrary
9830@kindex share
9831@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9832@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9833Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9834Unix regular expression.
9835As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9836required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9837@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9838loaded.
9839@end table
9840
b7209cb4
FF
9841On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9842autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9843reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9844by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9845up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9846wish.
c906108c
SS
9847
9848Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9849loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9850@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9851automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9852
9853To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9854
9855@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9856@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9857@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9858Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9859If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9860symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9861size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9862Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9863@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9864Mb).
c906108c 9865
b7209cb4
FF
9866@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9867@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9868Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9869@end table
c906108c 9870
6d2ebf8b 9871@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9872@section Errors reading symbol files
9873
9874While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9875such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9876output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9877they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9878debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9879about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9880only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9881times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9882to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9883complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9884messages}).
9885
9886The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9887
9888@table @code
9889@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9890
9891The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9892(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9893error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9894in its outer scope blocks.
9895
9896@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9897the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9898may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9899function.
9900
9901@item block at @var{address} out of order
9902
9903The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9904order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9905do so.
9906
9907@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9908locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9909can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9910@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9911messages}.)
9912
9913@item bad block start address patched
9914
9915The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9916smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9917to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9918
9919@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9920starting on the previous source line.
9921
9922@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9923
9924@cindex foo
9925Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9926larger than the size of the string table.
9927
9928@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9929name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9930with this name.
9931
9932@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9933
7a292a7a
SS
9934The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9935not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9936uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9937
7a292a7a
SS
9938@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9939This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9940are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9941debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9942on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9943and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9944
9945@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9946
7a292a7a 9947@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9948
7a292a7a 9949@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9950The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9951information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9952it.
c906108c
SS
9953
9954@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9955
9956@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9957
c906108c
SS
9958@end table
9959
6d2ebf8b 9960@node Targets
c906108c 9961@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9962
c906108c
SS
9963@cindex debugging target
9964@kindex target
9965
9966A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9967
9968Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9969in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9970you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9971flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9972host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9973realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9974command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9975(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9976
9977@menu
9978* Active Targets:: Active targets
9979* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9980* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9981* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9982* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9983
9984@end menu
9985
6d2ebf8b 9986@node Active Targets
c906108c 9987@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9988
c906108c
SS
9989@cindex stacking targets
9990@cindex active targets
9991@cindex multiple targets
9992
c906108c 9993There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9994executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9995active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9996start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9997a core file.
c906108c
SS
9998
9999For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10000@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10001well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10002@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10003first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10004requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10005are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10006read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10007executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10008
10009When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10010target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10011commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10012an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10013process target is active.
c906108c 10014
7a292a7a
SS
10015Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10016core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10017files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10018the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10019process}).
c906108c 10020
6d2ebf8b 10021@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10022@section Commands for managing targets
10023
10024@table @code
10025@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10026Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10027process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10028facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10029protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10030
10031Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10032typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10033with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10034
10035The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10036after executing the command.
10037
10038@kindex help target
10039@item help target
10040Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10041currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10042(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10043
10044@item help target @var{name}
10045Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10046select it.
10047
10048@kindex set gnutarget
10049@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10050@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10051knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10052a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10053with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10054with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10055
d4f3574e 10056@quotation
c906108c
SS
10057@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10058you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10059@end quotation
c906108c 10060
d4f3574e
SS
10061@noindent
10062@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10063
5d161b24 10064@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10065@item show gnutarget
10066Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10067@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10068@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10069and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10070@end table
10071
c906108c
SS
10072Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10073configuration):
c906108c
SS
10074
10075@table @code
10076@kindex target exec
10077@item target exec @var{program}
10078An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10079@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10080
c906108c
SS
10081@kindex target core
10082@item target core @var{filename}
10083A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10084@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10085
10086@kindex target remote
10087@item target remote @var{dev}
10088Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10089specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10090@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10091supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10092some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10093it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10094
c906108c
SS
10095@kindex target sim
10096@item target sim
2df3850c 10097Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10098In general,
474c8240 10099@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10100 target sim
10101 load
10102 run
474c8240 10103@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10104@noindent
104c1213 10105works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10106drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10107provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10108see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10109Processors}.
10110
c906108c
SS
10111@end table
10112
104c1213 10113Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10114
10115@table @code
10116
c906108c
SS
10117@kindex target nrom
10118@item target nrom @var{dev}
10119NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10120
c906108c
SS
10121@end table
10122
5d161b24 10123Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10124your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10125
10126Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10127once you've successfully established a connection.
10128
10129@table @code
10130
10131@kindex load @var{filename}
10132@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10133Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10134@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10135is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10136on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10137@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10138the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10139
10140If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10141execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10142target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10143
10144The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10145For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10146link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10147specifies a fixed address.
10148@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10149
c906108c
SS
10150@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10151@end table
10152
6d2ebf8b 10153@node Byte Order
c906108c 10154@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10155
c906108c
SS
10156@cindex choosing target byte order
10157@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10158
10159Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10160offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10161orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10162designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10163which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10164@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10165
10166@table @code
10167@kindex set endian big
10168@item set endian big
10169Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10170
10171@kindex set endian little
10172@item set endian little
10173Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10174
10175@kindex set endian auto
10176@item set endian auto
10177Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10178executable.
10179
10180@item show endian
10181Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10182
10183@end table
10184
10185Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10186data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10187target system.
10188
6d2ebf8b 10189@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10190@section Remote debugging
10191@cindex remote debugging
10192
10193If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10194@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10195For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10196or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10197powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10198
10199Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10200to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10201@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10202but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10203write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10204communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10205
10206Other remote targets may be available in your
10207configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10208
6f05cf9f
AC
10209@node KOD
10210@section Kernel Object Display
10211
10212@cindex kernel object display
10213@cindex kernel object
10214@cindex KOD
10215
10216Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10217@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10218and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10219mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10220displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10221
10222Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10223@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10224
474c8240 10225@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10226(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10227@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10228
10229If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10230about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10231which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10232after the operating system:
c906108c 10233
474c8240 10234@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10235(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10236List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10237Object Description
10238any Any and all objects
474c8240 10239@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10240
10241Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10242by the kernel.
10243
10244There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10245is supported other than to try it.
10246
10247
10248@node Remote Debugging
10249@chapter Debugging remote programs
10250
6b2f586d
AC
10251@menu
10252* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10253* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10254* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10255@end menu
10256
6f05cf9f
AC
10257@node Server
10258@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10259
10260@kindex gdbserver
10261@cindex remote connection without stubs
10262@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10263allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10264@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10265
10266@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10267because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10268that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10269@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10270@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10271because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10272also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10273started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10274Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10275the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10276do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10277by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10278choice for debugging.
10279
10280@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10281or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10282protocol.
10283
10284@table @emph
10285@item On the target machine,
10286you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10287@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10288strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10289system does all the symbol handling.
10290
10291To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10292the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10293syntax is:
10294
10295@smallexample
10296target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10297@end smallexample
10298
10299@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10300hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10301@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10302@file{/dev/com1}:
10303
10304@smallexample
10305target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10306@end smallexample
10307
10308@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10309with it.
10310
10311To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10312
10313@smallexample
10314target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10315@end smallexample
10316
10317The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10318specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10319TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10320expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10321(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10322you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10323TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10324reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10325conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10326and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10327@code{target remote} command.
10328
56460a61
DJ
10329On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10330This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10331
10332@smallexample
10333target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10334@end smallexample
10335
10336@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10337to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10338
6f05cf9f
AC
10339@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10340you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10341symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10342using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10343(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10344running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10345remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10346is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10347@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10348@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10349
10350@smallexample
10351(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10352@end smallexample
10353
10354@noindent
10355communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10356
10357@smallexample
10358(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10359@end smallexample
10360
10361@noindent
10362communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10363For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10364the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10365text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10366@samp{Connection refused}.
10367@end table
10368
10369@node NetWare
10370@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10371
10372@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10373@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10374allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10375@code{target remote}.
10376
10377@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10378using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10379
10380@table @emph
10381@item On the target machine,
10382you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10383@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10384can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10385host system does all the symbol handling.
10386
10387To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10388@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10389program. The syntax is:
10390
10391@smallexample
10392load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10393 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10394@end smallexample
10395
10396@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10397the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10398to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10399
10400For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10401communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10402using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10403
10404@smallexample
10405load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10406@end smallexample
10407
10408@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10409you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10410symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10411using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10412(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10413running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10414remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10415argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10416@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10417
10418@smallexample
10419(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10420@end smallexample
10421
10422@noindent
10423communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10424@end table
10425
10426@node remote stub
10427@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10428
8e04817f
AC
10429@cindex debugging stub, example
10430@cindex remote stub, example
10431@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10432The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10433communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10434@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10435these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10436implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10437with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10438organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10439
104c1213
JM
10440@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10441To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10442@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10443prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10444program, you need:
c906108c 10445
104c1213
JM
10446@enumerate
10447@item
10448A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10449have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10450your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10451
5d161b24 10452@item
d4f3574e 10453A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10454subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10455
104c1213
JM
10456@item
10457A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10458download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10459manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10460documentation.
10461@end enumerate
96baa820 10462
104c1213
JM
10463The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10464communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10465machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10466
104c1213
JM
10467@table @emph
10468@item On the host,
10469@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10470else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10471(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10472
10473@item On the target,
10474you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10475implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10476subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10477
10478On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10479@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10480@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10481@end table
96baa820 10482
104c1213
JM
10483The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10484machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10485@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10486
104c1213
JM
10487@cindex remote serial stub list
10488These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10489
104c1213
JM
10490@table @code
10491
10492@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10493@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10494@cindex Intel
10495@cindex i386
10496For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10497
10498@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10499@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10500@cindex Motorola 680x0
10501@cindex m680x0
10502For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10503
10504@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10505@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10506@cindex Hitachi
10507@cindex SH
10508For Hitachi SH architectures.
10509
10510@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10511@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10512@cindex Sparc
10513For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10514
10515@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10516@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10517@cindex Fujitsu
10518@cindex SparcLite
10519For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10520
10521@end table
10522
10523The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10524recently added stubs.
10525
10526@menu
10527* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10528* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10529* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10530@end menu
10531
6d2ebf8b 10532@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10533@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10534
10535@cindex remote serial stub
10536The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10537subroutines:
10538
10539@table @code
10540@item set_debug_traps
10541@kindex set_debug_traps
10542@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10543This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10544program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10545beginning of your program.
10546
10547@item handle_exception
10548@kindex handle_exception
10549@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10550This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10551explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10552run when a trap is triggered.
10553
10554@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10555execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10556with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10557protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10558representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10559information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10560retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10561execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10562@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10563machine.
104c1213
JM
10564
10565@item breakpoint
10566@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10567Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10568breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10569way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10570machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10571pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10572@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10573simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10574again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10575your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10576@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10577
10578Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10579to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10580start of your debugging session.
10581@end table
10582
6d2ebf8b 10583@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10584@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10585
10586@cindex remote stub, support routines
10587The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10588chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10589debugging target machine.
10590
10591First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10592serial port.
10593
10594@table @code
10595@item int getDebugChar()
10596@kindex getDebugChar
10597Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10598It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10599different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10600
10601@item void putDebugChar(int)
10602@kindex putDebugChar
10603Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10604It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10605different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10606@end table
10607
10608@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10609@cindex interrupting remote targets
10610If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10611running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10612for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10613character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10614remote system to stop.
10615
10616Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10617probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10618is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10619@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10620
10621Other routines you need to supply are:
10622
10623@table @code
10624@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10625@kindex exceptionHandler
10626Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10627handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10628way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10629are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10630containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10631@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10632its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10633might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10634exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10635@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10636and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10637you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10638should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10639
10640For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10641gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10642should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10643@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10644help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10645
10646@item void flush_i_cache()
10647@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10648On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10649instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10650instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10651
10652On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10653function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10654@end table
10655
10656@noindent
10657You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10658
10659@table @code
10660@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10661@kindex memset
10662This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10663memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10664@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10665either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10666@end table
10667
10668If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10669library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10670but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10671subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10672
10673
6d2ebf8b 10674@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10675@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10676
10677@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10678In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10679steps.
10680
10681@enumerate
10682@item
6d2ebf8b 10683Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10684(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10685@display
10686@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10687@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10688@end display
10689
10690@item
10691Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10692
474c8240 10693@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10694set_debug_traps();
10695breakpoint();
474c8240 10696@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10697
10698@item
10699For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10700@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10701
474c8240 10702@smallexample
104c1213 10703void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10704@end smallexample
104c1213 10705
d4f3574e 10706@noindent
104c1213 10707but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10708function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10709@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10710error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10711one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10712
10713@item
10714Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10715your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10716
10717@item
10718Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10719the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10720
10721@item
10722@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10723@c document that. FIXME.
10724Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10725whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10726
10727@item
10728To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10729as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10730This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10731of its pure text.
10732
d4f3574e 10733@item
104c1213 10734@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10735Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10736Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10737machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10738TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10739to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10740device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10741
474c8240 10742@smallexample
104c1213 10743target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10744@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10745
10746@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10747To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10748@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10749For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10750terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10751
474c8240 10752@smallexample
104c1213 10753target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10754@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10755
10756If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10757your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10758the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10759to port 1234 on your local machine:
10760
474c8240 10761@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10762target remote :1234
474c8240 10763@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10764@noindent
10765
10766Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10767
10768@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10769To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10770@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10771on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10772
10773@smallexample
10774target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10775@end smallexample
10776
10777When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10778that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10779busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10780session.
10781
104c1213
JM
10782@end enumerate
10783
10784Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10785step and continue the remote program.
10786
10787To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10788command.
10789
10790@cindex interrupting remote programs
10791@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10792Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10793interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10794program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10795and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10796interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10797
474c8240 10798@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10799Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10800Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10801@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10802
10803If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10804(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10805remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10806goes back to waiting.
10807
104c1213 10808
8e04817f
AC
10809@node Configurations
10810@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10811
8e04817f
AC
10812While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10813cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10814describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10815
8e04817f
AC
10816There are three major categories of configurations: native
10817configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10818operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10819different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10820are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10821
8e04817f
AC
10822@menu
10823* Native::
10824* Embedded OS::
10825* Embedded Processors::
10826* Architectures::
10827@end menu
104c1213 10828
8e04817f
AC
10829@node Native
10830@section Native
104c1213 10831
8e04817f
AC
10832This section describes details specific to particular native
10833configurations.
6cf7e474 10834
8e04817f
AC
10835@menu
10836* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10837* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10838* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10839* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10840@end menu
6cf7e474 10841
8e04817f
AC
10842@node HP-UX
10843@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10844
8e04817f
AC
10845On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10846begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10847name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10848
8e04817f
AC
10849@node SVR4 Process Information
10850@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10851
8e04817f
AC
10852@kindex /proc
10853@cindex process image
104c1213 10854
8e04817f
AC
10855Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10856used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10857subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10858this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10859several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10860@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10861@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10862and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
104c1213 10863
8e04817f
AC
10864@table @code
10865@kindex info proc
10866@item info proc
10867Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10868
8e04817f
AC
10869@kindex info proc mappings
10870@item info proc mappings
10871Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10872on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10873@ignore
10874@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10875@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10876@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10877@kindex info proc times
10878@item info proc times
10879Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10880its children.
6cf7e474 10881
8e04817f
AC
10882@kindex info proc id
10883@item info proc id
10884Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10885the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10886
8e04817f
AC
10887@kindex info proc status
10888@item info proc status
10889General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10890stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10891received.
d4f3574e 10892
8e04817f
AC
10893@item info proc all
10894Show all the above information about the process.
10895@end ignore
10896@end table
104c1213 10897
8e04817f
AC
10898@node DJGPP Native
10899@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10900@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10901@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10902@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10903
8e04817f
AC
10904@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10905MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10906that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10907top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10908
8e04817f
AC
10909@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10910defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10911subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10912
8e04817f
AC
10913@table @code
10914@kindex info dos
10915@item info dos
10916This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10917information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10918
8e04817f
AC
10919@kindex sysinfo
10920@cindex MS-DOS system info
10921@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10922@item info dos sysinfo
10923This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10924platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10925DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10926
8e04817f
AC
10927@cindex GDT
10928@cindex LDT
10929@cindex IDT
10930@cindex segment descriptor tables
10931@cindex descriptor tables display
10932@item info dos gdt
10933@itemx info dos ldt
10934@itemx info dos idt
10935These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10936and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10937tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10938that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10939descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10940descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10941rights.
104c1213 10942
8e04817f
AC
10943A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10944segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10945allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10946conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10947additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10948
8e04817f
AC
10949@cindex garbled pointers
10950These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10951Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10952displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10953display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10954example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10955debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10956
8e04817f
AC
10957@smallexample
10958@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10959@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10960@end smallexample
104c1213 10961
8e04817f
AC
10962@noindent
10963This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10964the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10965
8e04817f
AC
10966@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10967@item info dos pde
10968@itemx info dos pte
10969These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10970Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10971data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10972into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10973page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10974may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10975Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10976that is currently in use.
104c1213 10977
8e04817f
AC
10978Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10979Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10980the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10981@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10982Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10983means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10984the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10985
8e04817f
AC
10986@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10987These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10988Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10989controller.
104c1213 10990
8e04817f 10991These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10992
8e04817f
AC
10993@cindex physical address from linear address
10994@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10995This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10996address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10997appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10998accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10999example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11000the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11001
8e04817f
AC
11002@smallexample
11003@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11004@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11005@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11006@end smallexample
104c1213 11007
8e04817f
AC
11008@noindent
11009This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11010whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11011attributes of that page.
104c1213 11012
8e04817f
AC
11013Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11014since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11015address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11016be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11017declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11018@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11019
8e04817f
AC
11020Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11021transfer buffer:
104c1213 11022
8e04817f
AC
11023@smallexample
11024@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11025@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11026@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11027@end smallexample
104c1213 11028
8e04817f
AC
11029@noindent
11030(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
110313rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11032this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11033mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11034
8e04817f
AC
11035This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11036@end table
104c1213 11037
78c47bea
PM
11038@node Cygwin Native
11039@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11040@cindex MS Windows debugging
11041@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11042@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11043
11044@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
11045defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
11046subsection describes those commands.
11047
11048@table @code
11049@kindex info w32
11050@item info w32
11051This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11052information about the target system and important OS structures.
11053
11054@item info w32 selector
11055This command displays information returned by
11056the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11057It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11058a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11059Without argument, this command displays information
11060about the the six segment registers.
11061
11062@kindex info dll
11063@item info dll
11064This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11065
11066@kindex dll-symbols
11067@item dll-symbols
11068This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11069add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11070
11071@kindex set new-console
11072@item set new-console @var{mode}
11073If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11074be started in a new console on next start.
11075If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11076be started in the same console as the debugger.
11077
11078@kindex show new-console
11079@item show new-console
11080Displays whether a new console is used
11081when the debuggee is started.
11082
11083@kindex set new-group
11084@item set new-group @var{mode}
11085This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11086start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11087This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11088Ctrl-C.
11089
11090@kindex show new-group
11091@item show new-group
11092Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11093
11094@kindex set debugevents
11095@item set debugevents
11096This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11097
11098@kindex set debugexec
11099@item set debugexec
11100This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11101seen by the debugger.
11102
11103@kindex set debugexceptions
11104@item set debugexceptions
11105This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11106seen by the debugger.
11107
11108@kindex set debugmemory
11109@item set debugmemory
11110This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11111seen by the debugger.
11112
11113@kindex set shell
11114@item set shell
11115This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11116via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11117
11118@kindex show shell
11119@item show shell
11120Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11121
11122@end table
11123
8e04817f
AC
11124@node Embedded OS
11125@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11126
8e04817f
AC
11127This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11128embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11129architectures.
d4f3574e 11130
8e04817f
AC
11131@menu
11132* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11133@end menu
104c1213 11134
8e04817f
AC
11135@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11136various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11137
8e04817f
AC
11138@node VxWorks
11139@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11140
8e04817f 11141@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11142
8e04817f 11143@table @code
104c1213 11144
8e04817f
AC
11145@kindex target vxworks
11146@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11147A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11148is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11149
8e04817f 11150@end table
104c1213 11151
8e04817f
AC
11152On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11153current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11154
8e04817f
AC
11155@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11156VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11157the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11158both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11159@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11160installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11161@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11162
8e04817f
AC
11163@table @code
11164@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11165@kindex vxworks-timeout
11166All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11167This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11168seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11169your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11170of a thin network line.
11171@end table
104c1213 11172
8e04817f
AC
11173The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11174this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11175procedures.
104c1213 11176
8e04817f
AC
11177@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11178To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11179to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11180library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11181VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11182kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11183source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11184information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11185manual.
11186@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11187
8e04817f
AC
11188Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11189your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11190run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11191@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11192
8e04817f 11193@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11194
474c8240 11195@smallexample
8e04817f 11196(vxgdb)
474c8240 11197@end smallexample
104c1213 11198
8e04817f
AC
11199@menu
11200* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11201* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11202* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11203@end menu
104c1213 11204
8e04817f
AC
11205@node VxWorks Connection
11206@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11207
8e04817f
AC
11208The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11209network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11210
474c8240 11211@smallexample
8e04817f 11212(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11213@end smallexample
104c1213 11214
8e04817f
AC
11215@need 750
11216@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11217
8e04817f
AC
11218@smallexample
11219Attaching remote machine across net...
11220Connected to tt.
11221@end smallexample
104c1213 11222
8e04817f
AC
11223@need 1000
11224@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11225loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11226these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11227path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11228to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11229
474c8240 11230@smallexample
8e04817f 11231prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11232@end smallexample
104c1213 11233
8e04817f
AC
11234When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11235the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11236command again.
104c1213 11237
8e04817f
AC
11238@node VxWorks Download
11239@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11240
8e04817f
AC
11241@cindex download to VxWorks
11242If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11243object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11244@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11245incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11246command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11247to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11248table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11249the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11250filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11251Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11252to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11253the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11254@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11255and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11256program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11257
474c8240 11258@smallexample
8e04817f 11259-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11260@end smallexample
104c1213 11261
8e04817f
AC
11262@noindent
11263Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11264
474c8240 11265@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11266(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11267(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11268@end smallexample
104c1213 11269
8e04817f 11270@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11271
8e04817f
AC
11272@smallexample
11273Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11274@end smallexample
104c1213 11275
8e04817f
AC
11276You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11277after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11278this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11279auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11280history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11281debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11282table.)
104c1213 11283
8e04817f
AC
11284@node VxWorks Attach
11285@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11286
11287@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11288You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11289follows:
11290
474c8240 11291@smallexample
104c1213 11292(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11293@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11294
11295@noindent
11296where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11297or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11298the time of attachment.
11299
6d2ebf8b 11300@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11301@section Embedded Processors
11302
11303This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11304configurations.
11305
7d86b5d5 11306
104c1213 11307@menu
104c1213
JM
11308* ARM:: ARM
11309* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11310* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11311* i960:: Intel i960
11312* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11313* M68K:: Motorola M68K
7fb623f7 11314@c OBSOLETE * M88K:: Motorola M88K
104c1213
JM
11315* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11316* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11317* PowerPC: PowerPC
11318* SH:: Hitachi SH
11319* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11320* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11321* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11322* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11323@end menu
11324
6d2ebf8b 11325@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11326@subsection ARM
11327
11328@table @code
11329
8e04817f
AC
11330@kindex target rdi
11331@item target rdi @var{dev}
11332ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11333use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11334monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11335
11336@kindex target rdp
11337@item target rdp @var{dev}
11338ARM Demon monitor.
11339
11340@end table
11341
11342@node H8/300
11343@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11344
11345@table @code
11346
11347@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11348@item target hms @var{dev}
11349A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11350Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11351line and the communications speed used.
11352
11353@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11354@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11355E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11356
11357@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11358@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11359@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11360@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11361Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11362
11363@end table
11364
11365@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11366@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11367@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11368@cindex Hitachi SH download
11369When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11370board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11371board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11372@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11373
11374@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11375Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11376
11377@enumerate
11378@item
11379that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11380for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11381emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11382the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11383H8/300, or H8/500.)
11384
11385@item
11386what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11387serial device available on your host is the default).
11388
11389@item
11390what speed to use over the serial device.
11391@end enumerate
11392
11393@menu
11394* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11395* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11396* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11397@end menu
11398
11399@node Hitachi Boards
11400@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11401
11402@c only for Unix hosts
11403@kindex device
11404@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11405Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11406need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11407first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11408hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11409
11410@kindex speed
11411@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11412@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11413speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11414hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11415the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11416@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11417
11418The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11419use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11420use a DOS host,
11421@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11422called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11423through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11424to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11425
11426The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11427program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11428sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11429the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11430
11431First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11432board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11433port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11434When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11435debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11436for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11437@code{COM2}.
11438
474c8240 11439@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11440C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11441C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11442
11443Resident portion of MODE loaded
11444
11445COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11446
474c8240 11447@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11448
11449@quotation
11450@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11451@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11452disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11453your development board.
11454@end quotation
11455
11456@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11457Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11458connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11459the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11460you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11461commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11462cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11463download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11464the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11465(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11466executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11467@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11468itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11469
11470@smallexample
11471(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11472@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11473 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11474 the conditions.
11475There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11476for details.
11477@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11478(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11479Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11480(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11481.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11482.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11483.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11484@end smallexample
11485
11486At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11487you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11488sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11489@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11490resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11491@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11492
11493Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11494available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11495you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11496
11497Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11498@itemize @bullet
11499@item
11500to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11501no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11502
11503@item
11504to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11505normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11506to detect program completion.
11507@end itemize
11508
11509In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11510development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11511
11512@node Hitachi ICE
11513@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11514
11515@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11516You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11517Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11518e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11519
11520@table @code
11521@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11522Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11523@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11524@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11525(for example, @samp{9600}).
11526
11527@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11528If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11529specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11530@end table
11531
11532@node Hitachi Special
11533@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11534
11535Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11536
11537@table @code
11538
11539@kindex set machine
11540@kindex show machine
11541@item set machine h8300
11542@itemx set machine h8300h
11543Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11544architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11545to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11546
11547@end table
11548
8e04817f
AC
11549@node H8/500
11550@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11551
11552@table @code
11553
8e04817f
AC
11554@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11555@cindex memory models, H8/500
11556@item set memory @var{mod}
11557@itemx show memory
11558Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11559@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11560memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11561@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11562
8e04817f 11563@end table
104c1213 11564
8e04817f
AC
11565@node i960
11566@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11567
8e04817f 11568@table @code
104c1213 11569
8e04817f
AC
11570@kindex target mon960
11571@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11572MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11573
8e04817f
AC
11574@kindex target nindy
11575@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11576An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11577the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11578@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11579
8e04817f
AC
11580@end table
11581
11582@cindex Nindy
11583@cindex i960
11584@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11585@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11586tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11587
11588@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11589@item
8e04817f
AC
11590Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11591Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11592
11593@item
8e04817f 11594By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11595
11596@item
8e04817f
AC
11597By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11598session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11599
11600@end itemize
11601
11602@cindex download to Nindy-960
11603With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11604downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11605@value{GDBN}.
11606
11607@menu
11608* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11609* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11610* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11611@end menu
11612
11613@node Nindy Startup
11614@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11615
11616If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11617options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11618reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11619
474c8240 11620@smallexample
8e04817f 11621Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11622@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11623
11624@noindent
11625Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11626identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11627simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11628with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11629use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11630
11631@node Nindy Options
11632@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11633
11634These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11635Nindy-960 board attached:
11636
11637@table @code
11638@item -r @var{port}
11639Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11640to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11641configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11642@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11643device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11644suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11645
11646@item -O
11647(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11648the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11649This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11650target architecture.
11651
11652@quotation
11653@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11654connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11655fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11656attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11657this process with an interrupt.
11658@end quotation
11659
11660@item -brk
11661Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11662system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11663
11664@quotation
11665@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11666requires; it only works with a few boards.
11667@end quotation
11668@end table
11669
11670The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11671port.
11672
11673@c @group
11674@node Nindy Reset
11675@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11676
11677@table @code
11678@item reset
11679@kindex reset
11680For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11681system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11682circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11683a break is detected.
11684@end table
11685@c @end group
11686
11687@node M32R/D
11688@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11689
11690@table @code
11691
11692@kindex target m32r
11693@item target m32r @var{dev}
11694Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11695
11696@end table
11697
11698@node M68K
11699@subsection M68k
11700
11701The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11702target command for the following ROM monitors.
11703
11704@table @code
11705
11706@kindex target abug
11707@item target abug @var{dev}
11708ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11709
11710@kindex target cpu32bug
11711@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11712CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11713
11714@kindex target dbug
11715@item target dbug @var{dev}
11716dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11717
11718@kindex target est
11719@item target est @var{dev}
11720EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11721
11722@kindex target rom68k
11723@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11724ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11725
11726@end table
11727
11728If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11729instead have only a single special target command:
11730
11731@table @code
11732
11733@kindex target es1800
11734@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11735ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11736
11737@end table
11738
11739[context?]
11740
11741@table @code
11742
11743@kindex target rombug
11744@item target rombug @var{dev}
11745ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11746
11747@end table
11748
7fb623f7
AC
11749@c OBSOLETE @node M88K
11750@c OBSOLETE @subsection M88K
11751@c OBSOLETE
11752@c OBSOLETE @table @code
11753@c OBSOLETE
11754@c OBSOLETE @kindex target bug
11755@c OBSOLETE @item target bug @var{dev}
11756@c OBSOLETE BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11757@c OBSOLETE
11758@c OBSOLETE @end table
8e04817f
AC
11759
11760@node MIPS Embedded
11761@subsection MIPS Embedded
11762
11763@cindex MIPS boards
11764@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11765MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11766you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11767
8e04817f
AC
11768@need 1000
11769Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11770
8e04817f
AC
11771@table @code
11772@item target mips @var{port}
11773@kindex target mips @var{port}
11774To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11775name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11776command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11777the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11778been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11779download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11780
8e04817f
AC
11781For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11782port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11783debugger:
104c1213 11784
474c8240 11785@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11786host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11787@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11788(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11789(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11790(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11791@end smallexample
104c1213 11792
8e04817f
AC
11793@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11794On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11795connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11796concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11797@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11798
8e04817f
AC
11799@item target pmon @var{port}
11800@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11801PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11802
8e04817f
AC
11803@item target ddb @var{port}
11804@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11805NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11806
8e04817f
AC
11807@item target lsi @var{port}
11808@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11809LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11810
8e04817f
AC
11811@kindex target r3900
11812@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11813Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11814
8e04817f
AC
11815@kindex target array
11816@item target array @var{dev}
11817Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11818
8e04817f 11819@end table
104c1213 11820
104c1213 11821
8e04817f
AC
11822@noindent
11823@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11824
8e04817f
AC
11825@table @code
11826@item set processor @var{args}
11827@itemx show processor
11828@kindex set processor @var{args}
11829@kindex show processor
11830Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11831processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11832For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11833to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11834Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11835is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11836@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11837
8e04817f
AC
11838@item set mipsfpu double
11839@itemx set mipsfpu single
11840@itemx set mipsfpu none
11841@itemx show mipsfpu
11842@kindex set mipsfpu
11843@kindex show mipsfpu
11844@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11845@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11846If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11847coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11848need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11849file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11850functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11851@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11852functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11853with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11854processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11855double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11856@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11857
8e04817f
AC
11858In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11859floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11860and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11861
8e04817f
AC
11862As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11863@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11864
8e04817f
AC
11865@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11866@itemx show remotedebug
11867@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11868@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11869@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11870@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11871@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11872@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11873You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11874by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11875@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11876to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11877at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11878
8e04817f
AC
11879@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11880@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11881@itemx show timeout
11882@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11883@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11884@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11885@kindex set timeout
11886@kindex show timeout
11887@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11888@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11889You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11890remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11891default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11892waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11893retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11894You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11895retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11896@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11897
8e04817f
AC
11898The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11899is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11900forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11901to run before stopping.
11902@end table
104c1213 11903
8e04817f
AC
11904@node PowerPC
11905@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11906
11907@table @code
104c1213 11908
8e04817f
AC
11909@kindex target dink32
11910@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11911DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11912
8e04817f
AC
11913@kindex target ppcbug
11914@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11915@kindex target ppcbug1
11916@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11917PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11918
8e04817f
AC
11919@kindex target sds
11920@item target sds @var{dev}
11921SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11922
11923@end table
11924
11925@node PA
11926@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11927
11928@table @code
11929
8e04817f
AC
11930@kindex target op50n
11931@item target op50n @var{dev}
11932OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11933
11934@kindex target w89k
11935@item target w89k @var{dev}
11936W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11937
11938@end table
11939
8e04817f
AC
11940@node SH
11941@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11942
11943@table @code
11944
8e04817f
AC
11945@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11946@item target hms @var{dev}
11947A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11948commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11949the communications speed used.
104c1213 11950
8e04817f
AC
11951@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11952@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11953E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11954
8e04817f
AC
11955@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11956@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11957@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11958@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11959Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11960
8e04817f 11961@end table
104c1213 11962
8e04817f
AC
11963@node Sparclet
11964@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11965
8e04817f
AC
11966@cindex Sparclet
11967
11968@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11969Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11970@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11971both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11972@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 11973
8e04817f
AC
11974@table @code
11975@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11976@kindex remotetimeout
11977@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11978This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11979seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11980@end table
11981
8e04817f
AC
11982@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11983When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11984information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11985load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11986@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 11987
474c8240 11988@smallexample
8e04817f 11989sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 11990@end smallexample
104c1213 11991
8e04817f 11992You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 11993
474c8240 11994@smallexample
8e04817f 11995sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 11996@end smallexample
104c1213 11997
8e04817f
AC
11998@cindex running, on Sparclet
11999Once you have set
12000your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12001run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12002(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12003
8e04817f
AC
12004@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12005
474c8240 12006@smallexample
8e04817f 12007(gdbslet)
474c8240 12008@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12009
12010@menu
8e04817f
AC
12011* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12012* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12013* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12014* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12015@end menu
12016
8e04817f
AC
12017@node Sparclet File
12018@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12019
8e04817f 12020The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12021
474c8240 12022@smallexample
8e04817f 12023(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12024@end smallexample
104c1213 12025
8e04817f
AC
12026@need 1000
12027@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12028@value{GDBN} locates
12029the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12030path.
12031If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12032files will be searched as well.
12033@value{GDBN} locates
12034the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12035path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12036If it fails
12037to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12038
474c8240 12039@smallexample
8e04817f 12040prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12041@end smallexample
104c1213 12042
8e04817f
AC
12043When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12044the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12045@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12046
8e04817f
AC
12047@node Sparclet Connection
12048@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12049
8e04817f
AC
12050The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12051To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12052
474c8240 12053@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12054(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12055Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12056main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12057@end smallexample
104c1213 12058
8e04817f
AC
12059@need 750
12060@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12061
474c8240 12062@smallexample
8e04817f 12063Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12064@end smallexample
104c1213 12065
8e04817f
AC
12066@node Sparclet Download
12067@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12068
8e04817f
AC
12069@cindex download to Sparclet
12070Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12071you can use the @value{GDBN}
12072@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12073The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12074command.
12075Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12076address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12077offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12078of each of the file's sections.
12079For instance, if the program
12080@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12081and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12082
474c8240 12083@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12084(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12085Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12086@end smallexample
104c1213 12087
8e04817f
AC
12088If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12089to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12090to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12091
12092@node Sparclet Execution
12093@subsubsection Running and debugging
12094
12095@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12096You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12097commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12098manual for the list of commands.
12099
474c8240 12100@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12101(gdbslet) b main
12102Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12103(gdbslet) run
12104Starting program: prog
12105Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
121063 char *symarg = 0;
12107(gdbslet) step
121084 char *execarg = "hello!";
12109(gdbslet)
474c8240 12110@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12111
12112@node Sparclite
12113@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12114
12115@table @code
12116
8e04817f
AC
12117@kindex target sparclite
12118@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12119Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12120You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12121For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12122remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12123
12124@end table
12125
8e04817f
AC
12126@node ST2000
12127@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12128
8e04817f
AC
12129@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12130STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12131
8e04817f
AC
12132To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12133manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12134
474c8240 12135@smallexample
8e04817f 12136target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12137@end smallexample
104c1213 12138
8e04817f
AC
12139@noindent
12140to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12141the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12142ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12143connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12144concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12145
8e04817f
AC
12146The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12147this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12148would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12149(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12150available on your host computer.
12151@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12152@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12153
8e04817f
AC
12154@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12155These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12156environment:
104c1213 12157
8e04817f
AC
12158@table @code
12159@item st2000 @var{command}
12160@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12161@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12162@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12163Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12164manual for available commands.
104c1213 12165
8e04817f
AC
12166@item connect
12167@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12168Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12169you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12170sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12171@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12172@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12173@end table
12174
8e04817f
AC
12175@node Z8000
12176@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12177
8e04817f
AC
12178@cindex Z8000
12179@cindex simulator, Z8000
12180@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12181
8e04817f
AC
12182When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12183a Z8000 simulator.
12184
12185For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12186unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12187segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12188appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12189
8e04817f
AC
12190@table @code
12191@item target sim @var{args}
12192@kindex sim
12193@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12194Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12195options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12196@end table
12197
8e04817f
AC
12198@noindent
12199After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12200CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12201@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12202to run your program, and so on.
12203
12204As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12205(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12206additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12207
12208@table @code
12209
8e04817f
AC
12210@item cycles
12211Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12212
8e04817f
AC
12213@item insts
12214Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12215
8e04817f
AC
12216@item time
12217Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12218
8e04817f 12219@end table
104c1213 12220
8e04817f
AC
12221You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12222conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12223conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12224simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12225
8e04817f
AC
12226@node Architectures
12227@section Architectures
104c1213 12228
8e04817f
AC
12229This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12230all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12231
8e04817f
AC
12232@menu
12233* A29K::
12234* Alpha::
12235* MIPS::
12236@end menu
104c1213 12237
8e04817f
AC
12238@node A29K
12239@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12240
12241@table @code
104c1213 12242
8e04817f
AC
12243@kindex set rstack_high_address
12244@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12245@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12246@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12247On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12248@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12249extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12250stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12251memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12252this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12253the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12254address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12255hexadecimal.
104c1213 12256
8e04817f
AC
12257@kindex show rstack_high_address
12258@item show rstack_high_address
12259Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12260processors.
104c1213 12261
8e04817f 12262@end table
104c1213 12263
8e04817f
AC
12264@node Alpha
12265@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12266
8e04817f 12267See the following section.
104c1213 12268
8e04817f
AC
12269@node MIPS
12270@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12271
8e04817f
AC
12272@cindex stack on Alpha
12273@cindex stack on MIPS
12274@cindex Alpha stack
12275@cindex MIPS stack
12276Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12277sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12278find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12279
8e04817f
AC
12280@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12281To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12282@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12283you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12284commands:
104c1213 12285
8e04817f
AC
12286@table @code
12287@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12288@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12289Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12290search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12291default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12292larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12293and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12294
8e04817f
AC
12295@item show heuristic-fence-post
12296Display the current limit.
12297@end table
104c1213
JM
12298
12299@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12300These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12301for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12302
104c1213 12303
8e04817f
AC
12304@node Controlling GDB
12305@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12306
12307You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12308@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12309data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12310described here.
12311
12312@menu
12313* Prompt:: Prompt
12314* Editing:: Command editing
12315* History:: Command history
12316* Screen Size:: Screen size
12317* Numbers:: Numbers
12318* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12319* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12320@end menu
12321
12322@node Prompt
12323@section Prompt
104c1213 12324
8e04817f 12325@cindex prompt
104c1213 12326
8e04817f
AC
12327@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12328called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12329can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12330instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12331the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12332which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12333
8e04817f
AC
12334@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12335prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12336or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12337
8e04817f
AC
12338@table @code
12339@kindex set prompt
12340@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12341Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12342
8e04817f
AC
12343@kindex show prompt
12344@item show prompt
12345Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12346@end table
12347
8e04817f
AC
12348@node Editing
12349@section Command editing
12350@cindex readline
12351@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12352
8e04817f
AC
12353@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12354@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12355command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12356or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12357substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12358debugging sessions.
104c1213 12359
8e04817f
AC
12360You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12361command @code{set}.
104c1213 12362
8e04817f
AC
12363@table @code
12364@kindex set editing
12365@cindex editing
12366@item set editing
12367@itemx set editing on
12368Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12369
8e04817f
AC
12370@item set editing off
12371Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@kindex show editing
12374@item show editing
12375Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12376@end table
12377
8e04817f
AC
12378@node History
12379@section Command history
12380
12381@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12382debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12383happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12384history facility.
104c1213
JM
12385
12386@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12387@cindex history substitution
12388@cindex history file
12389@kindex set history filename
12390@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12391@item set history filename @var{fname}
12392Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12393This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12394list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12395exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12396the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12397to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12398@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12399is not set.
104c1213 12400
8e04817f
AC
12401@cindex history save
12402@kindex set history save
12403@item set history save
12404@itemx set history save on
12405Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12406@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12407
8e04817f
AC
12408@item set history save off
12409Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12410
8e04817f
AC
12411@cindex history size
12412@kindex set history size
12413@item set history size @var{size}
12414Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12415This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12416@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12417@end table
12418
8e04817f
AC
12419@cindex history expansion
12420History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12421@ifset have-readline-appendices
12422@xref{Event Designators}.
12423@end ifset
12424
12425Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12426is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12427@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12428follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12429a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12430history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12431@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12432
12433The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12434
12435@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12436@kindex set history expansion
12437@item set history expansion on
12438@itemx set history expansion
12439Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12440
8e04817f
AC
12441@item set history expansion off
12442Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12443
8e04817f
AC
12444The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12445editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12446or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12447@ifset have-readline-appendices
12448@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12449@end ifset
104c1213 12450
8e04817f
AC
12451@c @group
12452@kindex show history
12453@item show history
12454@itemx show history filename
12455@itemx show history save
12456@itemx show history size
12457@itemx show history expansion
12458These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12459@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12460@c @end group
12461@end table
12462
12463@table @code
12464@kindex shows
12465@item show commands
12466Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12467
8e04817f
AC
12468@item show commands @var{n}
12469Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12470
12471@item show commands +
12472Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12473@end table
12474
8e04817f
AC
12475@node Screen Size
12476@section Screen size
12477@cindex size of screen
12478@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12479
8e04817f
AC
12480Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12481information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12482@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12483output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12484to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12485determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12486printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12487rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12488
12489Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12490driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12491together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12492@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12493you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12494width} commands:
12495
12496@table @code
12497@kindex set height
12498@kindex set width
12499@kindex show width
12500@kindex show height
12501@item set height @var{lpp}
12502@itemx show height
12503@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12504@itemx show width
12505These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12506a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12507commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12508
8e04817f
AC
12509If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12510output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12511file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12512
8e04817f
AC
12513Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12514from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12515@end table
12516
8e04817f
AC
12517@node Numbers
12518@section Numbers
12519@cindex number representation
12520@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12521
8e04817f
AC
12522You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12523@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12524@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12525begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12526default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12527numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12528change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12529radix} command.
104c1213 12530
8e04817f
AC
12531@table @code
12532@kindex set input-radix
12533@item set input-radix @var{base}
12534Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12535for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12536specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12537example, any of
104c1213 12538
8e04817f
AC
12539@smallexample
12540set radix 012
12541set radix 10.
12542set radix 0xa
12543@end smallexample
104c1213 12544
8e04817f
AC
12545@noindent
12546sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12547leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12548
8e04817f
AC
12549@kindex set output-radix
12550@item set output-radix @var{base}
12551Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12552for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12553specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12554
8e04817f
AC
12555@kindex show input-radix
12556@item show input-radix
12557Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12558
8e04817f
AC
12559@kindex show output-radix
12560@item show output-radix
12561Display the current default base for numeric display.
12562@end table
104c1213 12563
8e04817f
AC
12564@node Messages/Warnings
12565@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12566
8e04817f
AC
12567By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12568running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12569command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12570internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12571
8e04817f
AC
12572Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12573which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12574see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12575
8e04817f
AC
12576@table @code
12577@kindex set verbose
12578@item set verbose on
12579Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12580
8e04817f
AC
12581@item set verbose off
12582Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12583
8e04817f
AC
12584@kindex show verbose
12585@item show verbose
12586Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12587@end table
104c1213 12588
8e04817f
AC
12589By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12590object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12591find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12592symbol files}).
104c1213 12593
8e04817f 12594@table @code
104c1213 12595
8e04817f
AC
12596@kindex set complaints
12597@item set complaints @var{limit}
12598Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12599unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12600@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12601to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12602
8e04817f
AC
12603@kindex show complaints
12604@item show complaints
12605Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12606
8e04817f 12607@end table
104c1213 12608
8e04817f
AC
12609By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12610lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12611you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12612
474c8240 12613@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12614(@value{GDBP}) run
12615The program being debugged has been started already.
12616Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12617@end smallexample
104c1213 12618
8e04817f
AC
12619If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12620commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12621
8e04817f 12622@table @code
104c1213 12623
8e04817f
AC
12624@kindex set confirm
12625@cindex flinching
12626@cindex confirmation
12627@cindex stupid questions
12628@item set confirm off
12629Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12630
8e04817f
AC
12631@item set confirm on
12632Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12633
8e04817f
AC
12634@kindex show confirm
12635@item show confirm
12636Displays state of confirmation requests.
12637
12638@end table
104c1213 12639
8e04817f
AC
12640@node Debugging Output
12641@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12642@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12643@kindex set debug arch
12644@item set debug arch
12645Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12646@kindex show debug arch
12647@item show debug arch
12648Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12649@kindex set debug event
12650@item set debug event
12651Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12652default is off.
12653@kindex show debug event
12654@item show debug event
12655Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12656info.
12657@kindex set debug expression
12658@item set debug expression
12659Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12660default is off.
12661@kindex show debug expression
12662@item show debug expression
12663Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12664debugging info.
12665@kindex set debug overload
12666@item set debug overload
12667Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12668info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12669is off.
12670@kindex show debug overload
12671@item show debug overload
12672Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12673debugging info.
12674@kindex set debug remote
12675@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12676@cindex serial connections, debugging
12677@item set debug remote
12678Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12679the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12680@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12681@kindex show debug remote
12682@item show debug remote
12683Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12684@kindex set debug serial
12685@item set debug serial
12686Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12687default is off.
12688@kindex show debug serial
12689@item show debug serial
12690Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12691info.
12692@kindex set debug target
12693@item set debug target
12694Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12695includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12696default is off.
12697@kindex show debug target
12698@item show debug target
12699Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12700info.
12701@kindex set debug varobj
12702@item set debug varobj
12703Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12704info. The default is off.
12705@kindex show debug varobj
12706@item show debug varobj
12707Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12708debugging info.
12709@end table
104c1213 12710
8e04817f
AC
12711@node Sequences
12712@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12713
8e04817f
AC
12714Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12715command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12716commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12717files.
104c1213 12718
8e04817f
AC
12719@menu
12720* Define:: User-defined commands
12721* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12722* Command Files:: Command files
12723* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12724@end menu
104c1213 12725
8e04817f
AC
12726@node Define
12727@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12728
8e04817f
AC
12729@cindex user-defined command
12730A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12731which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12732@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12733separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12734via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12735
8e04817f
AC
12736@smallexample
12737define adder
12738 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12739@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12740
12741@noindent
8e04817f 12742To execute the command use:
104c1213 12743
8e04817f
AC
12744@smallexample
12745adder 1 2 3
12746@end smallexample
104c1213 12747
8e04817f
AC
12748@noindent
12749This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12750its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12751reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12752functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12753
12754@table @code
104c1213 12755
8e04817f
AC
12756@kindex define
12757@item define @var{commandname}
12758Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12759by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12760
8e04817f
AC
12761The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12762which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12763commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12764
8e04817f
AC
12765@kindex if
12766@kindex else
12767@item if
12768Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12769It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12770only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12771There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12772by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12773was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12774
8e04817f
AC
12775@kindex while
12776@item while
12777The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12778which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12779execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12780The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12781evaluates to true.
104c1213 12782
8e04817f
AC
12783@kindex document
12784@item document @var{commandname}
12785Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12786accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12787defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12788reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12789After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12790@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12791
8e04817f
AC
12792You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12793documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12794does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12795
8e04817f
AC
12796@kindex help user-defined
12797@item help user-defined
12798List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12799(if any) for each.
104c1213 12800
8e04817f
AC
12801@kindex show user
12802@item show user
12803@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12804Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12805not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12806definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12807
20f01a46
DH
12808@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12809@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12810@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12811@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12812The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12813levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12814infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12815
104c1213
JM
12816@end table
12817
8e04817f
AC
12818When user-defined commands are executed, the
12819commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12820stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12821
8e04817f
AC
12822If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12823without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12824commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12825messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12826
8e04817f
AC
12827@node Hooks
12828@section User-defined command hooks
12829@cindex command hooks
12830@cindex hooks, for commands
12831@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12832
8e04817f
AC
12833@kindex hook
12834@kindex hook-
12835You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12836command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12837command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12838before that command.
104c1213 12839
8e04817f
AC
12840@cindex hooks, post-command
12841@kindex hookpost
12842@kindex hookpost-
12843A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12844Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12845@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12846that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12847pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12848
8e04817f
AC
12849It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12850occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12851
8e04817f
AC
12852@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12853@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12854
8e04817f
AC
12855@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12856In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12857(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12858execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12859displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12860
8e04817f
AC
12861For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12862single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12863you could define:
104c1213 12864
474c8240 12865@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12866define hook-stop
12867handle SIGALRM nopass
12868end
104c1213 12869
8e04817f
AC
12870define hook-run
12871handle SIGALRM pass
12872end
104c1213 12873
8e04817f
AC
12874define hook-continue
12875handle SIGLARM pass
12876end
474c8240 12877@end smallexample
104c1213 12878
8e04817f
AC
12879As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12880command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12881you could define:
104c1213 12882
474c8240 12883@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12884define hook-echo
12885echo <<<---
12886end
104c1213 12887
8e04817f
AC
12888define hookpost-echo
12889echo --->>>\n
12890end
104c1213 12891
8e04817f
AC
12892(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12893<<<---Hello World--->>>
12894(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12895
474c8240 12896@end smallexample
104c1213 12897
8e04817f
AC
12898You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12899not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12900name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12901@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12902@c or not?
12903If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12904@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12905(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12906
8e04817f
AC
12907If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12908get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12909
8e04817f
AC
12910@node Command Files
12911@section Command files
c906108c 12912
8e04817f
AC
12913@cindex command files
12914A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12915commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12916An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12917the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 12918
8e04817f
AC
12919@cindex init file
12920@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12921@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12922When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12923@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12924port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12925limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12926During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 12927
8e04817f
AC
12928@enumerate
12929@item
12930Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12931DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12932@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 12933
8e04817f
AC
12934@item
12935Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 12936
8e04817f
AC
12937@item
12938Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 12939
8e04817f
AC
12940@item
12941Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12942@end enumerate
c906108c 12943
8e04817f
AC
12944The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12945complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12946and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12947option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12948
8e04817f
AC
12949@cindex init file name
12950On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12951different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12952form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12953different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12954environments with special init file names:
c906108c 12955
8e04817f
AC
12956@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12957@itemize @bullet
12958@item
12959VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12960
8e04817f
AC
12961@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12962@item
12963OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12964
8e04817f
AC
12965@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12966@item
12967ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12968@end itemize
c906108c 12969
8e04817f
AC
12970You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12971@code{source} command:
c906108c 12972
8e04817f
AC
12973@table @code
12974@kindex source
12975@item source @var{filename}
12976Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
12977@end table
12978
8e04817f 12979The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
12980printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
12981execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 12982
8e04817f
AC
12983Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12984without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12985normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12986when called from command files.
c906108c 12987
8e04817f
AC
12988@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
12989mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
12990standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
12991not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
12992the next command.
c906108c 12993
474c8240 12994@smallexample
8e04817f 12995gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 12996@end smallexample
c906108c 12997
8e04817f
AC
12998(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
12999will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13000would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13001
8e04817f
AC
13002@node Output
13003@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13004
8e04817f
AC
13005During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13006@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13007explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13008describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13009want.
c906108c
SS
13010
13011@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13012@kindex echo
13013@item echo @var{text}
13014@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13015@c because it is not in ANSI.
13016Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13017@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13018newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13019In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13020by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13021string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13022trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13023To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13024@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13025
8e04817f
AC
13026A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13027the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13028
474c8240 13029@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13030echo This is some text\n\
13031which is continued\n\
13032onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13033@end smallexample
c906108c 13034
8e04817f 13035produces the same output as
c906108c 13036
474c8240 13037@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13038echo This is some text\n
13039echo which is continued\n
13040echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13041@end smallexample
c906108c 13042
8e04817f
AC
13043@kindex output
13044@item output @var{expression}
13045Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13046newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13047value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13048on expressions.
c906108c 13049
8e04817f
AC
13050@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13051Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13052the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13053formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13054
8e04817f
AC
13055@kindex printf
13056@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13057Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13058@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13059either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13060@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13061subroutine
13062@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13063@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13064@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13065@c supported.
c906108c 13066
474c8240 13067@smallexample
8e04817f 13068printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13069@end smallexample
c906108c 13070
8e04817f 13071For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13072
8e04817f
AC
13073@smallexample
13074printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13075@end smallexample
c906108c 13076
8e04817f
AC
13077The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13078string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13079letter.
c906108c
SS
13080@end table
13081
8e04817f
AC
13082@node TUI
13083@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13084@cindex TUI
c906108c 13085
8e04817f
AC
13086@menu
13087* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13088* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13089* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13090* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13091@end menu
c906108c 13092
8e04817f
AC
13093The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13094is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13095to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13096and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13097The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13098with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13099
8e04817f
AC
13100@node TUI Overview
13101@section TUI overview
c906108c 13102
8e04817f
AC
13103The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13104@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13105
8e04817f
AC
13106@itemize @bullet
13107@item
13108A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13109windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13110
8e04817f
AC
13111@item
13112A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13113the TUI.
13114@end itemize
c906108c 13115
8e04817f
AC
13116In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13117on the terminal:
c906108c 13118
8e04817f
AC
13119@table @emph
13120@item command
13121This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13122prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13123managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13124window is always visible.
c906108c 13125
8e04817f
AC
13126@item source
13127The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13128line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13129The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
13130active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
c906108c 13131
8e04817f
AC
13132@item assembly
13133The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13134
8e04817f
AC
13135@item register
13136This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13137a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13138changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13139
c906108c
SS
13140@end table
13141
8e04817f
AC
13142The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13143and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13144changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13145These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13146layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13147The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13148
8e04817f
AC
13149@itemize @bullet
13150@item
13151source
2df3850c 13152
8e04817f
AC
13153@item
13154assembly
13155
13156@item
13157source and assembly
13158
13159@item
13160source and registers
c906108c 13161
8e04817f
AC
13162@item
13163assembly and registers
2df3850c 13164
8e04817f 13165@end itemize
c906108c 13166
8e04817f
AC
13167@node TUI Keys
13168@section TUI Key Bindings
13169@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13170
8e04817f
AC
13171The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13172(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13173They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13174directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
13175are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13176
8e04817f
AC
13177@table @kbd
13178@kindex C-x C-a
13179@item C-x C-a
13180@kindex C-x a
13181@itemx C-x a
13182@kindex C-x A
13183@itemx C-x A
13184Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13185the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13186its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13187mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13188The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13189
8e04817f
AC
13190@kindex C-x 1
13191@item C-x 1
13192Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13193either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13194is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13195
8e04817f 13196Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13197
8e04817f
AC
13198@kindex C-x 2
13199@item C-x 2
13200Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13201layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13202When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13203previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13204
8e04817f 13205Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13206
c906108c
SS
13207@end table
13208
8e04817f 13209The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13210
8e04817f
AC
13211@table @key
13212@kindex PgUp
13213@item PgUp
13214Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13215
8e04817f
AC
13216@kindex PgDn
13217@item PgDn
13218Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13219
8e04817f
AC
13220@kindex Up
13221@item Up
13222Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13223
8e04817f
AC
13224@kindex Down
13225@item Down
13226Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13227
8e04817f
AC
13228@kindex Left
13229@item Left
13230Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13231
8e04817f
AC
13232@kindex Right
13233@item Right
13234Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13235
8e04817f
AC
13236@kindex C-L
13237@item C-L
13238Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13239
8e04817f 13240@end table
c906108c 13241
8e04817f
AC
13242In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13243for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13244necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13245@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13246
13247@node TUI Commands
13248@section TUI specific commands
13249@cindex TUI commands
13250
13251The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13252These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13253the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13254is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13255in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13256
13257@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13258@item layout next
13259@kindex layout next
13260Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13261
8e04817f
AC
13262@item layout prev
13263@kindex layout prev
13264Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13265
8e04817f
AC
13266@item layout src
13267@kindex layout src
13268Display the source window only.
c906108c 13269
8e04817f
AC
13270@item layout asm
13271@kindex layout asm
13272Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13273
8e04817f
AC
13274@item layout split
13275@kindex layout split
13276Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13277
8e04817f
AC
13278@item layout regs
13279@kindex layout regs
13280Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13281
13282@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13283@kindex focus
13284Set the focus to the named window.
13285This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13286can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13287
8e04817f
AC
13288@item refresh
13289@kindex refresh
13290Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13291
8e04817f
AC
13292@item update
13293@kindex update
13294Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13295
8e04817f
AC
13296@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13297@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13298@kindex winheight
13299Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13300lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13301decrease it.
2df3850c 13302
c906108c
SS
13303@end table
13304
8e04817f
AC
13305@node TUI Configuration
13306@section TUI configuration variables
13307@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13308
8e04817f
AC
13309The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13310appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13311
8e04817f
AC
13312@table @code
13313@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13314@kindex set tui border-kind
13315Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13316The possible values are the following:
13317@table @code
13318@item space
13319Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13320
8e04817f
AC
13321@item ascii
13322Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13323
8e04817f
AC
13324@item acs
13325Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13326drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13327
8e04817f 13328@end table
c78b4128 13329
8e04817f
AC
13330@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13331@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13332Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13333The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13334@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13335
8e04817f
AC
13336@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13337@kindex set tui border-mode
13338Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13339The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13340@table @code
13341@item normal
13342Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13343
8e04817f
AC
13344@item standout
13345Use standout mode.
c906108c 13346
8e04817f
AC
13347@item reverse
13348Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13349
8e04817f
AC
13350@item half
13351Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13352
8e04817f
AC
13353@item half-standout
13354Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13355
8e04817f
AC
13356@item bold
13357Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13358
8e04817f
AC
13359@item bold-standout
13360Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13361
8e04817f 13362@end table
c78b4128 13363
8e04817f 13364@end table
c78b4128 13365
8e04817f
AC
13366@node Emacs
13367@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13368
8e04817f
AC
13369@cindex Emacs
13370@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13371A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13372edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13373@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13374
8e04817f
AC
13375To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13376executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13377@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13378created Emacs buffer.
13379@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13380
8e04817f
AC
13381Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13382things:
c906108c 13383
8e04817f
AC
13384@itemize @bullet
13385@item
13386All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13387@end itemize
c906108c 13388
8e04817f
AC
13389This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13390and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13391
8e04817f
AC
13392This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13393commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13394in this way.
bf0184be 13395
8e04817f
AC
13396All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13397with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13398way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13399stop.
bf0184be 13400
8e04817f 13401@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13402@item
8e04817f
AC
13403@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13404@end itemize
bf0184be 13405
8e04817f
AC
13406Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13407source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13408left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13409source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13410and the source.
bf0184be 13411
8e04817f
AC
13412Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13413usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13414
8e04817f
AC
13415@quotation
13416@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13417current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13418the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13419appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13420environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13421session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13422back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13423avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13424your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13425@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13426
8e04817f
AC
13427A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13428switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13429@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13430@end quotation
13431
13432By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13433you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13434several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13435Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13436
474c8240 13437@smallexample
8e04817f 13438(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13439@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13440
13441@noindent
13442(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13443in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13444``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13445
13446In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13447addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13448
8e04817f
AC
13449@table @kbd
13450@item C-h m
13451Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13452
8e04817f
AC
13453@item M-s
13454Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13455update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13456
8e04817f
AC
13457@item M-n
13458Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13459calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13460to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13461
8e04817f
AC
13462@item M-i
13463Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13464display window accordingly.
c906108c 13465
8e04817f
AC
13466@item M-x gdb-nexti
13467Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13468display window accordingly.
c906108c 13469
8e04817f
AC
13470@item C-c C-f
13471Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13472@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13473
8e04817f
AC
13474@item M-c
13475Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13476command.
b433d00b 13477
8e04817f 13478@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13479
8e04817f
AC
13480@item M-u
13481Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13482(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13483like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13484
8e04817f 13485@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13486
8e04817f
AC
13487@item M-d
13488Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13489@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13490
8e04817f 13491@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13492
8e04817f
AC
13493@item C-x &
13494Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13495of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13496around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13497then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13498argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13499
8e04817f
AC
13500You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13501@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13502otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13503inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13504wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13505list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13506formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13507is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13508@end table
c906108c 13509
8e04817f
AC
13510In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13511tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13512
8e04817f
AC
13513If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13514it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13515request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13516the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13517frame.
c906108c 13518
8e04817f
AC
13519The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13520which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13521the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13522communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13523delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13524to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13525
8e04817f
AC
13526@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13527@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13528@ignore
13529@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13530@kindex Epoch
13531@kindex inspect
c906108c 13532
8e04817f
AC
13533Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13534called the @code{epoch}
13535environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13536@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13537each value is printed in its own window.
13538@end ignore
c906108c 13539
8e04817f
AC
13540@include annotate.texi
13541@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13542
8e04817f
AC
13543@node GDB Bugs
13544@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13545@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13546@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13547
8e04817f 13548Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13549
8e04817f
AC
13550Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13551may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13552the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13553reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13554
8e04817f
AC
13555In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13556information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13557
13558@menu
8e04817f
AC
13559* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13560* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13561@end menu
13562
8e04817f
AC
13563@node Bug Criteria
13564@section Have you found a bug?
13565@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13566
8e04817f 13567If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13568
13569@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13570@cindex fatal signal
13571@cindex debugger crash
13572@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13573@item
8e04817f
AC
13574If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13575@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13576
13577@cindex error on valid input
13578@item
13579If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13580bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13581somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13582
8e04817f 13583@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13584@item
8e04817f
AC
13585If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13586that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13587``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13588for traditional practice''.
13589
13590@item
13591If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13592for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13593@end itemize
13594
8e04817f
AC
13595@node Bug Reporting
13596@section How to report bugs
13597@cindex bug reports
13598@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13599
13600A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13601If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13602contact that organization first.
13603
13604You can find contact information for many support companies and
13605individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13606distribution.
13607@c should add a web page ref...
13608
129188f6
AC
13609In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13610@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13611@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13612page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13613be used.
8e04817f
AC
13614
13615@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13616@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13617not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13618@samp{bug-gdb}.
13619
13620The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13621serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13622the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13623newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13624problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13625path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13626we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13627bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13628
8e04817f
AC
13629The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13630@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13631fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13632
8e04817f
AC
13633Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13634problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13635assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13636Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13637stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13638name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13639of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13640the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13641easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13642
8e04817f
AC
13643Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13644bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13645you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13646self-contained.
c4555f82 13647
8e04817f
AC
13648Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13649bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13650@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13651bugs properly.
13652
13653To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13654
13655@itemize @bullet
13656@item
8e04817f
AC
13657The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13658with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13659version}.
c4555f82 13660
8e04817f
AC
13661Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13662the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13663
13664@item
8e04817f
AC
13665The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13666version number.
c4555f82
SC
13667
13668@item
8e04817f
AC
13669What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13670``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13671
13672@item
8e04817f
AC
13673What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13674debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13675C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13676information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13677compilers.
c4555f82 13678
8e04817f
AC
13679@item
13680The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13681observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13682you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13683Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13684
8e04817f
AC
13685If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13686and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13687
8e04817f
AC
13688@item
13689A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13690reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13691
8e04817f
AC
13692@item
13693A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13694incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13695
8e04817f
AC
13696Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13697will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13698not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13699a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13700
8e04817f
AC
13701Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13702say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13703copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13704the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13705crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13706ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13707us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13708to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13709
8e04817f
AC
13710@item
13711If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13712diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13713it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13714
8e04817f
AC
13715The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13716sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13717
8e04817f 13718@end itemize
c4555f82 13719
8e04817f 13720Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13721
8e04817f
AC
13722@itemize @bullet
13723@item
13724A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13725
8e04817f
AC
13726Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13727which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13728changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13729
8e04817f
AC
13730This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13731will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13732with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13733We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13734
8e04817f
AC
13735Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13736of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13737output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13738less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13739
8e04817f
AC
13740However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13741report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13742
8e04817f
AC
13743@item
13744A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13745
8e04817f
AC
13746A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13747the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13748a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13749to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13750
8e04817f
AC
13751Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13752construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13753through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13754to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13755
8e04817f
AC
13756And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13757patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13758help us to understand.
c4555f82 13759
8e04817f
AC
13760@item
13761A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13762
8e04817f
AC
13763Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13764things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13765@end itemize
c4555f82 13766
8e04817f
AC
13767@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13768@c and consists of the two following files:
13769@c rluser.texinfo
13770@c inc-hist.texinfo
13771@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13772@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13773@include rluser.texinfo
13774@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13775
c4555f82 13776
8e04817f
AC
13777@node Formatting Documentation
13778@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13779
8e04817f
AC
13780@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13781@cindex reference card
13782The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13783for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13784subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13785@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13786release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13787you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 13788
8e04817f
AC
13789The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13790can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 13791
474c8240 13792@smallexample
8e04817f 13793make refcard.dvi
474c8240 13794@end smallexample
c4555f82 13795
8e04817f
AC
13796The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13797mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13798that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13799high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13800your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 13801
8e04817f 13802@cindex documentation
c4555f82 13803
8e04817f
AC
13804All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13805distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13806a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13807on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13808formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13809and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 13810
8e04817f
AC
13811@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13812version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13813file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13814subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13815necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13816but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13817Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13818@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 13819
8e04817f
AC
13820If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13821Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13822@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 13823
8e04817f
AC
13824If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13825@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13826version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 13827
474c8240 13828@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13829cd gdb
13830make gdb.info
474c8240 13831@end smallexample
c4555f82 13832
8e04817f
AC
13833If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13834a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13835Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 13836
8e04817f
AC
13837@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13838produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13839document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13840has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13841command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13842(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13843require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 13844
8e04817f
AC
13845@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13846@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13847written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13848typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13849and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13850directory.
c4555f82 13851
8e04817f
AC
13852If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13853typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13854subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13855@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 13856
474c8240 13857@smallexample
8e04817f 13858make gdb.dvi
474c8240 13859@end smallexample
c4555f82 13860
8e04817f 13861Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 13862
8e04817f
AC
13863@node Installing GDB
13864@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13865@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13866@cindex installation
c4555f82 13867
8e04817f
AC
13868@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13869of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13870build the @code{gdb} program.
13871@iftex
13872@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13873@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13874look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13875installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13876@end iftex
c4555f82 13877
8e04817f
AC
13878The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13879@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13880appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 13881
8e04817f
AC
13882For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13883@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 13884
8e04817f
AC
13885@table @code
13886@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13887script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 13888
8e04817f
AC
13889@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13890the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 13891
8e04817f
AC
13892@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13893source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 13894
8e04817f
AC
13895@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13896@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 13897
8e04817f
AC
13898@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13899source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 13900
8e04817f
AC
13901@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13902source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 13903
8e04817f
AC
13904@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13905source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 13906
8e04817f
AC
13907@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13908source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 13909
8e04817f
AC
13910@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13911source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13912@end table
c906108c 13913
8e04817f
AC
13914The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13915from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13916this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 13917
8e04817f
AC
13918First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13919if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13920identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13921argument.
c906108c 13922
8e04817f 13923For example:
c906108c 13924
474c8240 13925@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13926cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13927./configure @var{host}
13928make
474c8240 13929@end smallexample
c906108c 13930
8e04817f
AC
13931@noindent
13932where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13933@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13934(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13935correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 13936
8e04817f
AC
13937Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13938@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13939libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13940binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 13941
8e04817f
AC
13942@need 750
13943@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13944system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13945shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 13946
474c8240 13947@smallexample
8e04817f 13948sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 13949@end smallexample
c906108c 13950
8e04817f
AC
13951If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13952directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13953@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13954creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13955you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13956
13957You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13958subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13959configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 13960
8e04817f
AC
13961For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13962the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 13963
474c8240 13964@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13965@group
13966cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13967../configure @var{host}
13968@end group
474c8240 13969@end smallexample
c906108c 13970
8e04817f
AC
13971You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13972However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13973the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13974that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13975let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 13976
8e04817f
AC
13977@menu
13978* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13979* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13980* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13981@end menu
c906108c 13982
8e04817f
AC
13983@node Separate Objdir
13984@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 13985
8e04817f
AC
13986If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13987you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13988host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13989allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13990rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13991handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13992@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13993program specified there.
c906108c 13994
8e04817f
AC
13995To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13996with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13997(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13998itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13999would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14000the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14001
8e04817f
AC
14002For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14003separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14004
474c8240 14005@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14006@group
14007cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14008mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14009cd ../gdb-sun4
14010../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14011make
14012@end group
474c8240 14013@end smallexample
c906108c 14014
8e04817f
AC
14015When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14016directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14017(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14018the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14019directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14020@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14021
8e04817f
AC
14022One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14023directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14024@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14025programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14026You specify a cross-debugging target by
14027giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14028
8e04817f
AC
14029When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14030it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14031called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14032
8e04817f
AC
14033The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14034directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14035directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14036directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14037will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14038
8e04817f
AC
14039When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14040directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14041if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14042with each other.
c906108c 14043
8e04817f
AC
14044@node Config Names
14045@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14046
8e04817f
AC
14047The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14048script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14049aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14050of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14051
474c8240 14052@smallexample
8e04817f 14053@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14054@end smallexample
c906108c 14055
8e04817f
AC
14056For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14057or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14058option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14059
8e04817f
AC
14060The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14061any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14062aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14063@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14064script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14065abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14066
8e04817f
AC
14067@smallexample
14068% sh config.sub i386-linux
14069i386-pc-linux-gnu
14070% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14071alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14072% sh config.sub hp9k700
14073hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14074% sh config.sub sun4
14075sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14076% sh config.sub sun3
14077m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14078% sh config.sub i986v
14079Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14080@end smallexample
c906108c 14081
8e04817f
AC
14082@noindent
14083@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14084directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14085
8e04817f
AC
14086@node Configure Options
14087@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14088
8e04817f
AC
14089Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14090are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14091several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14092Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14093
474c8240 14094@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14095configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14096 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14097 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14098 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14099 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14100 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14101 @var{host}
474c8240 14102@end smallexample
c906108c 14103
8e04817f
AC
14104@noindent
14105You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14106@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14107@samp{--}.
c906108c 14108
8e04817f
AC
14109@table @code
14110@item --help
14111Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14112
8e04817f
AC
14113@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14114Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14115@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14116
8e04817f
AC
14117@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14118Configure the source to install programs under directory
14119@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14120
8e04817f
AC
14121@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14122@need 2000
14123@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14124@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14125@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14126Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14127@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14128build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14129directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14130the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14131directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14132the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14133@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14134
8e04817f
AC
14135@item --norecursion
14136Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14137propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14138
8e04817f
AC
14139@item --target=@var{target}
14140Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14141@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14142programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14143
8e04817f 14144There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14145
8e04817f
AC
14146@item @var{host} @dots{}
14147Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14148
8e04817f
AC
14149There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14150@end table
c906108c 14151
8e04817f
AC
14152There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14153needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14154
8e04817f
AC
14155@node Maintenance Commands
14156@appendix Maintenance Commands
14157@cindex maintenance commands
14158@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14159
8e04817f
AC
14160In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14161includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14162These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14163
8e04817f
AC
14164@table @code
14165@kindex maint info breakpoints
14166@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14167Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14168breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14169internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14170breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14171is shown:
c906108c 14172
8e04817f
AC
14173@table @code
14174@item breakpoint
14175Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14176
8e04817f
AC
14177@item watchpoint
14178Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14179
8e04817f
AC
14180@item longjmp
14181Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14182@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14183
8e04817f
AC
14184@item longjmp resume
14185Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14186
8e04817f
AC
14187@item until
14188Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14189
8e04817f
AC
14190@item finish
14191Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14192
8e04817f
AC
14193@item shlib events
14194Shared library events.
c906108c 14195
8e04817f 14196@end table
c906108c 14197
8e04817f 14198@end table
c906108c 14199
c906108c 14200
e0ce93ac 14201@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14202@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14203
8e04817f
AC
14204There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14205protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14206machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14207recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14208
8e04817f
AC
14209In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
14210transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14211
8e04817f
AC
14212@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14213@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14214@cindex remote serial protocol
14215All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14216sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14217@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14218@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14219
474c8240 14220@smallexample
8e04817f 14221@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14222@end smallexample
8e04817f 14223@noindent
c906108c 14224
8e04817f
AC
14225@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14226@noindent
14227The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14228characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14229eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14230
8e04817f
AC
14231Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14232specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14233
474c8240 14234@smallexample
8e04817f 14235@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14236@end smallexample
c906108c 14237
8e04817f
AC
14238@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14239@noindent
14240That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14241has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14242since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14243
8e04817f
AC
14244@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14245When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14246response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14247the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14248retransmission):
c906108c 14249
474c8240 14250@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14251<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14252-> @code{+}
474c8240 14253@end smallexample
8e04817f 14254@noindent
53a5351d 14255
8e04817f
AC
14256The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14257debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14258the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14259when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14260
8e04817f
AC
14261@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14262exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14263exceptions).
c906108c 14264
8e04817f
AC
14265Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14266@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14267HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14268
8e04817f
AC
14269Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14270@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14271would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14272
8e04817f
AC
14273Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14274means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14275which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14276@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14277where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14278characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14279value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14280
8e04817f
AC
14281Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14282loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14283character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14284
8e04817f 14285So:
474c8240 14286@smallexample
8e04817f 14287"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14288@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14289@noindent
14290means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14291
8e04817f
AC
14292The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14293error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14294
8e04817f
AC
14295For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14296(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14297protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14298on that response.
c906108c 14299
8e04817f
AC
14300A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14301@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14302optional.
c906108c 14303
8e04817f
AC
14304Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
14305their corresponding response @var{data}:
14306@page
14307@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
14308@item Packet
14309@tab Request
14310@tab Description
c906108c 14311
8e04817f
AC
14312@item extended mode
14313@tab @code{!}
14314@tab
14315Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14316persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14317debugged.
c906108c 14318@item
8e04817f
AC
14319@tab reply @samp{OK}
14320@tab
14321The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
c906108c 14322
8e04817f
AC
14323@item last signal
14324@tab @code{?}
14325@tab
14326Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
14327and continue.
14328@item
14329@tab reply
14330@tab see below
c906108c
SS
14331
14332
8e04817f
AC
14333@item reserved
14334@tab @code{a}
14335@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14336
8e04817f
AC
14337@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14338@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
14339@tab
14340@item
14341@tab
14342@tab
14343Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14344specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14345See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
14346@item
14347@tab reply @code{OK}
14348@item
14349@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
c906108c 14350
8e04817f
AC
14351@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14352@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
14353@tab
14354Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
14355transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
14356transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
14357acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
14358to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
14359ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
14360specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
14361that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
14362happened.}
c906108c 14363
8e04817f
AC
14364@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14365@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
14366@tab
14367Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14368breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
14369@samp{z} packets.}
c906108c 14370
8e04817f
AC
14371@item continue
14372@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
14373@tab
14374@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14375current address.
14376@item
14377@tab reply
14378@tab see below
c906108c 14379
8e04817f
AC
14380@item continue with signal
14381@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14382@tab
14383Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14384@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14385@item
14386@tab reply
14387@tab see below
c906108c 14388
8e04817f
AC
14389@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14390@tab @code{d}
14391@tab
14392toggle debug flag.
c906108c 14393
8e04817f
AC
14394@item detach
14395@tab @code{D}
14396@tab
14397Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
14398@value{GDBN} disconnects.
14399@item
14400@tab reply @emph{no response}
14401@tab
14402@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
c906108c 14403
8e04817f
AC
14404@item reserved
14405@tab @code{e}
14406@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14407
8e04817f
AC
14408@item reserved
14409@tab @code{E}
14410@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14411
8e04817f
AC
14412@item reserved
14413@tab @code{f}
14414@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14415
8e04817f
AC
14416@item reserved
14417@tab @code{F}
14418@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14419
8e04817f
AC
14420@item read registers
14421@tab @code{g}
14422@tab Read general registers.
14423@item
14424@tab reply @var{XX...}
14425@tab
14426Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14427with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14428each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14429determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
14430@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14431@code{g} packets is specified below.
14432@item
14433@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
14434@tab for an error.
c906108c 14435
8e04817f
AC
14436@item write regs
14437@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
14438@tab
14439See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
14440@item
14441@tab reply @code{OK}
14442@tab for success
14443@item
14444@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14445@tab for an error
c906108c 14446
8e04817f
AC
14447@item reserved
14448@tab @code{h}
14449@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14450
8e04817f
AC
14451@item set thread
14452@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
14453@tab
14454Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14455@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
14456continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
14457thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
14458@item
14459@tab reply @code{OK}
14460@tab for success
14461@item
14462@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14463@tab for an error
c906108c 14464
8e04817f
AC
14465@c FIXME: JTC:
14466@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14467@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14468@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14469@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14470@c described. For example:
14471@c
14472@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14473@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14474@c otherwise returns current registers.
14475@c
14476@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14477@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14478@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14479
8e04817f
AC
14480@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14481@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
14482@tab
14483Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14484present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14485step starting at that address.
c906108c 14486
8e04817f
AC
14487@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14488@tab @code{I}
14489@tab
14490See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
c906108c 14491
8e04817f
AC
14492@item reserved
14493@tab @code{j}
14494@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14495
8e04817f
AC
14496@item reserved
14497@tab @code{J}
14498@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14499
8e04817f
AC
14500@item kill request
14501@tab @code{k}
14502@tab
ac282366 14503FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
6ca652b0 14504thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
c906108c 14505
8e04817f
AC
14506@item reserved
14507@tab @code{l}
14508@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14509
8e04817f
AC
14510@item reserved
14511@tab @code{L}
14512@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14513
8e04817f
AC
14514@item read memory
14515@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14516@tab
14517Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14518Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
14519using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
14520transfer mechanism is needed.}
14521@item
14522@tab reply @var{XX...}
14523@tab
14524@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14525to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
14526sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
14527@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
14528@item
14529@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14530@tab @var{NN} is errno
c906108c 14531
8e04817f
AC
14532@item write mem
14533@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
14534@tab
14535Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14536@var{XX...} is the data.
14537@item
14538@tab reply @code{OK}
14539@tab for success
14540@item
14541@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14542@tab
14543for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14544written).
c906108c 14545
8e04817f
AC
14546@item reserved
14547@tab @code{n}
14548@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14549
8e04817f
AC
14550@item reserved
14551@tab @code{N}
14552@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14553
8e04817f
AC
14554@item reserved
14555@tab @code{o}
14556@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14557
8e04817f
AC
14558@item reserved
14559@tab @code{O}
14560@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14561
8e04817f
AC
14562@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14563@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
14564@tab
14565See write register.
14566@item
14567@tab return @var{r....}
14568@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
c906108c 14569
8e04817f
AC
14570@item write reg
14571@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
14572@tab
14573Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
14574digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
14575@item
14576@tab reply @code{OK}
14577@tab for success
14578@item
14579@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14580@tab for an error
c906108c 14581
8e04817f
AC
14582@item general query
14583@tab @code{q}@var{query}
14584@tab
14585Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
14586have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
14587company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
14588optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
14589must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
14590@item
14591@tab reply @code{XX...}
14592@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14593@item
14594@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14595@tab error reply
14596@item
14597@tab reply @samp{}
14598@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
c906108c 14599
8e04817f
AC
14600@item general set
14601@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
14602@tab
14603Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
14604naming conventions.
c906108c 14605
8e04817f
AC
14606@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14607@tab @code{r}
14608@tab
14609Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14610
8e04817f
AC
14611@item remote restart
14612@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
14613@tab
14614Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14615This packet is only available in extended mode.
14616@item
14617@tab
14618no reply
14619@tab
14620The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
c906108c 14621
8e04817f
AC
14622@item step
14623@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
14624@tab
14625@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14626same address.
14627@item
14628@tab reply
14629@tab see below
c906108c 14630
8e04817f
AC
14631@item step with signal
14632@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14633@tab
14634Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
14635@item
14636@tab reply
14637@tab see below
c906108c 14638
8e04817f
AC
14639@item search
14640@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
14641@tab
14642Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
14643@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
14644bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14645
8e04817f
AC
14646@item thread alive
14647@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
14648@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
14649@item
14650@tab reply @code{OK}
14651@tab thread is still alive
14652@item
14653@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14654@tab thread is dead
c906108c 14655
8e04817f
AC
14656@item reserved
14657@tab @code{u}
14658@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14659
8e04817f
AC
14660@item reserved
14661@tab @code{U}
14662@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14663
8e04817f
AC
14664@item reserved
14665@tab @code{v}
14666@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14667
8e04817f
AC
14668@item reserved
14669@tab @code{V}
14670@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14671
8e04817f
AC
14672@item reserved
14673@tab @code{w}
14674@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14675
8e04817f
AC
14676@item reserved
14677@tab @code{W}
14678@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14679
8e04817f
AC
14680@item reserved
14681@tab @code{x}
14682@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14683
8e04817f
AC
14684@item write mem (binary)
14685@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
14686@tab
14687@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
14688binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
14689escaped using @code{0x7d}.
14690@item
14691@tab reply @code{OK}
14692@tab for success
14693@item
14694@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14695@tab for an error
c906108c 14696
8e04817f
AC
14697@item reserved
14698@tab @code{y}
14699@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14700
8e04817f
AC
14701@item reserved
14702@tab @code{Y}
14703@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14704
8e04817f
AC
14705@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14706@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14707@tab
14708See @samp{Z}.
c906108c 14709
8e04817f
AC
14710@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14711@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14712@tab
14713@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
14714breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
14715@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
14716bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
14717the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14718@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
14719potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
14720implemented in an idempotent way.
14721@item
14722@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14723@tab for an error
14724@item
14725@tab reply @code{OK}
14726@tab for success
14727@item
14728@tab @samp{}
14729@tab If not supported.
c906108c 14730
8e04817f
AC
14731@item reserved
14732@tab <other>
14733@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14734
8e04817f 14735@end multitable
c906108c 14736
8e04817f
AC
14737The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
14738receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
14739@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
14740when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
14741number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
14742conventions is used.
c906108c 14743
8e04817f 14744@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
c906108c 14745
8e04817f
AC
14746@item @code{S}@var{AA}
14747@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 14748
8e04817f
AC
14749@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
14750@tab
14751@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
14752(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
14753by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
14754thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
14755@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
14756integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
14757@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
14758to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 14759
8e04817f
AC
14760@item @code{W}@var{AA}
14761@tab
14762The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
14763applicable for certains sorts of targets.
c906108c 14764
8e04817f
AC
14765@item @code{X}@var{AA}
14766@tab
14767The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 14768
8e04817f
AC
14769@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
14770@tab
14771@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
14772@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
14773@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
14774this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
14775spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
14776debugger.}
c906108c 14777
8e04817f
AC
14778@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
14779@tab
14780@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
14781while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
14782for 'W', 'T', etc.
c906108c 14783
8e04817f 14784@end multitable
c906108c 14785
8e04817f 14786The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 14787
8e04817f 14788@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
c906108c 14789
8e04817f
AC
14790@item current thread
14791@tab @code{q}@code{C}
14792@tab Return the current thread id.
14793@item
14794@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
14795@tab
14796Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
14797@item
14798@tab reply *
14799@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
c906108c 14800
8e04817f
AC
14801@item all thread ids
14802@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14803@item
14804@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
14805@tab
14806Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
14807may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
14808works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
14809obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
14810be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
14811sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
14812@item
14813@tab
14814@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
14815@item
14816@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
14817@tab A single thread id
14818@item
14819@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
14820@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
14821@item
14822@tab reply @code{l}
14823@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
14824@item
14825@tab
14826@tab
14827In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
14828or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
14829respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
14830@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
14831(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 14832
8e04817f
AC
14833@item extra thread info
14834@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
14835@tab
14836@item
14837@tab
14838@tab
14839Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
14840Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
14841the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
14842thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
14843The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
14844Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
14845"Blocked on Mutex".
14846@item
14847@tab reply @var{XX...}
14848@tab
14849Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
14850printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
14851attributes.
c906108c 14852
8e04817f
AC
14853@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
14854@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
14855@tab
14856@item
14857@tab
14858@tab
14859Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
14860digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
14861subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
14862number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
14863(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
14864returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
14865@item
14866@tab
14867@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14868query (see above).
14869@item
14870@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
14871@tab
14872@item
14873@tab
14874@tab
14875Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
14876returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
14877and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
14878digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
14879a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
14880digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
c906108c 14881
8e04817f
AC
14882@item compute CRC of memory block
14883@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14884@tab
14885@item
14886@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14887@tab An error (such as memory fault)
14888@item
14889@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
14890@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
c906108c 14891
8e04817f
AC
14892@item query sect offs
14893@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
14894@tab
14895Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
14896image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
14897response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
14898offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
14899@item
14900@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
c906108c 14901
8e04817f
AC
14902@item thread info request
14903@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
14904@tab
14905@item
14906@tab
14907@tab
14908Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
14909encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
14910@item
14911@tab reply *
14912@tab
14913See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 14914
8e04817f
AC
14915@item remote command
14916@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
14917@tab
14918@item
14919@tab
14920@tab
14921@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
14922execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
14923Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
14924number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
14925packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
14926stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
14927@item
14928@tab reply @code{OK}
14929@tab
14930A command response with no output.
14931@item
14932@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
14933@tab
14934A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
14935@item
14936@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14937@tab
14938Indicate a badly formed request.
c906108c 14939
8e04817f
AC
14940@item
14941@tab reply @samp{}
14942@tab
14943When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
c906108c 14944
8e04817f
AC
14945@item symbol lookup
14946@tab @code{qSymbol::}
14947@tab
14948Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
14949requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
14950@item
14951@tab
14952@tab
14953@item
14954@tab reply @code{OK}
14955@tab
14956The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14957@item
14958@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14959@tab
14960@sp 2
14961@noindent
14962The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14963@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
14964@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14965message, described below.
5d161b24 14966
8e04817f
AC
14967@item symbol value
14968@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14969@tab
14970@sp 1
14971@noindent
14972Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
14973@item
14974@tab
14975@tab
14976@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
14977the target has previously requested.
14978@item
14979@tab
14980@tab
14981@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
14982If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
14983field will be empty.
14984@item
14985@tab reply @code{OK}
14986@tab
14987The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14988@item
14989@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14990@tab
14991@sp 2
14992@noindent
14993The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14994@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
14995until the target ceases to request them.
eb12ee30 14996
8e04817f 14997@end multitable
eb12ee30 14998
8e04817f
AC
14999The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
15000In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
15001bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
15002space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
15003The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
15004least-significant.
eb12ee30 15005
8e04817f 15006@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
eb12ee30 15007
8e04817f
AC
15008@item MIPS32
15009@tab
15010All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1501132 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15012registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15013
8e04817f
AC
15014@item MIPS64
15015@tab
15016All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15017thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15018as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15019
8e04817f 15020@end multitable
eb12ee30 15021
8e04817f
AC
15022Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15023does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15024
474c8240 15025@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
15026<- @code{R00}
15027-> @code{+}
15028@emph{target restarts}
15029<- @code{?}
15030-> @code{+}
15031-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15032<- @code{+}
474c8240 15033@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15034
8e04817f 15035Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15036
474c8240 15037@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
15038<- @code{G1445...}
15039-> @code{+}
15040<- @code{s}
15041-> @code{+}
15042@emph{time passes}
15043-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15044<- @code{+}
15045<- @code{g}
15046-> @code{+}
15047-> @code{1455...}
15048<- @code{+}
474c8240 15049@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15050
aab4e0ec 15051@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15052
6826cf00
EZ
15053@include fdl.texi
15054
6d2ebf8b 15055@node Index
c906108c
SS
15056@unnumbered Index
15057
15058@printindex cp
15059
15060@tex
15061% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15062% meantime:
15063\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15064\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15065\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15066\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15067\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15068\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15069\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15070\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15071\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15072\page\colophon
15073% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15074@end tex
15075
c906108c 15076@bye
This page took 0.995089 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.